Asda A2 Manual
Asda A2 Manual
0
DELTA_IA-ASDA_A2_UM_EN_20141212
Preface
Thank you for purchasing ASDA-A2. This user manual provides the related information of ASDA-
A2R series servo drive and ECMA series servo motors. This manual includes:
Before using the product, please read through this manual carefully in order to ensure the correct
use of the product. In addition, please place this manual safely for quick reference whenever is
needed. Please follow the rules below if you have not finished reading this manual yet.
No water, corrosive gas and inflammable gas are allowed in installation environment.
Three-phase power is prohibited to connect to U, V and W connector when wiring. It is
possible to damage the servo drive.
Ground is a must.
Do not disconnect the servo drive, motor or change the wiring when connecting to the
power.
Be ensured that the emergency stop can be activated anytime before connecting to the
power and operation.
Do not touch the heat sink to avoid scald before connecting to the power and operation.
If you have any enquiry, please contact the distributors or DEALTA customer service center.
Safety Precautions
ASDA-A2 series is the high resolution and open type servo drive. It should be installed in a
shielded control box during operation. This servo drive uses precise feedback control and the
digital signal processor with high-speed calculation function to control the current output which
generated by IGBT so as to operate three-phase permanent magnet synchronous motors (PMSM)
and to achieve precise positioning.
Pay special attention to the following safety precautions anytime during inspection, installation,
wiring, operation and examination.
It indicates the potential hazards. It is possible to cause severe injury or fatal harm if not
follow the instructions.
It indicates the potential hazards. It is possible to cause minor injury or lead to serious
damage of the product or even malfunction if not follow the instructions.
Inspection
Please follow the instruction when using servo drive and servo motor, or it is possible
to cause fire or malfunction.
Installation
It is prohibited to expose the product with the environment which containing water,
corrosive gas, inflammable gas, etc. Or it is possible to cause electric shock or fire.
Wiring
Please connect the ground terminal to class-3 ground system (under 100 Ω); poor
grounding may result in electric shock or fire.
Do not connect the three-phase source to the motor output terminal U, V and W. Or it
is possible to cause personnel injury or fire.
Please tighten the screws of the power and motor output terminal. Or it is possible to
cause fire.
Please connect wiring according to the wire rod in order to prevent any danger.
Operation
Before the operation, please change the parameter setting value according to the
needs. If it is not adjusted to the correct setting value, it is possible to lead to
malfunction of the machine or the operation might out of control.
Before the machine starts to operate, please be ensured the emergency stop can be
activated anytime.
When power on, please make sure the motor shaft stands still and will not operate
because of mechanical inertia or other causes.
In order to prevent any accident, please separate the couplings and belts of the
machine and isolate them. Then conduct the initial trial run.
If users fail to operate the machine properly after the servo motor connects to the
equipment, it would cause the damage of the equipment and lead to the personnel
injury.
In order to prevent the danger, it is strongly recommended to check if the motor can
operate normally without load first. Then, operate the motor with load.
Do not touch the heat sink of the servo drive. Or it is possible to cause scald due to
the high temperature.
Do not turn the power on and off too often. If continuous power on and off is needed,
please be ensured the interval is one minute at most.
NOTE If there is any difference of each version, please refer to DELTA’s website
(http://www.delta.com.tw/industrialautomation/) for the latest information.
3.4.5 Application: Using CN1 Quick Connector for Wiring ......................................... 3-50
7.5 The Difference between General PR Mode and the One in ASDA-A2 ................... 7-12
7.10.1 The Relation between the Previous Path and the Next Path ............................ 7-25
12.3.6 Use Digital Inputs/Outputs to Read the Absolute Coordinate Data ............... 12-19
12.5 Digital Input (DI) Function Definition (for Absolute System) .................................. 12-30
12.6 Digital Output (DO) Function Definition (for Absolute System) ............................. 12-31
User Information
Be sure to store this manual in a safe place.
Due to constantly growing product range, technical improvement and alteration or changed texts,
figures and diagrams, we reserve the right of this manual contained information change without
prior notice.
Coping or reproducing any part of this manual, without written consent of Delta Electronics Inc. is
prohibited.
ASIA JAPAN
DELTA ELECTRONICS, INC. DELTA ELECTRONICS (JAPAN), INC.
Taoyuan Plant 1 Tokyo Office
31-1, XINGBANG ROAD, DELTA SHIBADAIMON BUILDING
GUISHAN INDUSTRIAL ZONE, 2-1-14 SHIBADAIMON, MINATO-KU,
TAOYUAN COUNTY 33370, TAIWAN, R.O.C. TOKYO, 105-0012, JAPAN
TEL: 886-3-362-6301 TEL: 81-3-5733-1111
FAX: 886-3-362-7267 FAX: 81-3-5733-1211
Explanation
1.1 Inspection
In order to prevent the negligence during purchasing and delivery, please inspect the following
items carefully.
Please check if the product is what you have purchased: check the part number of the
motor and the servo drive on the nameplate. Refer to the next page for the model
explanation.
Check if the motor shaft can rotate smoothly: Rotate the motor shaft by hand. If it can be
rotated smoothly, it means the motor shaft is normal. However, it cannot be rotated by hand
if the motor has an electromagnetic brake.
Check if there is any damage shown on its appearance: visually check if there is any
damage or scrape of the appearance.
Check if there is any loose screw: If the screws are un-tightened or fall off.
If any of the above situations happens, please contact the distributors to solve the problems.
A complete and workable servo set should include:
(1) A Servo drive and a servo motor
(2) A UVW motor power cable, the U, V and W wires can connect to the socket attached by
the servo drive and another side is the plug which could connect to the socket of the
motor. And a green ground wire which should be locked to the ground terminal of the
servo drive. (selective purchase)
(3) An encoder cable which connects to the socket of the encoder. One side of it connects to
CN2 servo drive and another side is the plug. (selective purchase)
(4) 50-PIN connector which is used in CN1 (3M analog product) (selective purchase)
(5) 20-PIN connector which is used in CN2 (3M analog product) (selective purchase)
(6) 6-PIN connector which is used in CN3 (IEEE 1394 analog product) and is for general
communication (RS485) (selective purchase)
(7) 4-PIN connector which used in CN4 (USB Type B product) (selective purchase)
(8) RJ45 connector which used in CN6 and is for high-speed communication (selective
purchase)
(9) 7-PIN connector which used in CN7, for extension DI. (-U model) (selective purchase)
400V:
Control circuit power Main circuit power
750 W ~ 1.5 kW DC24V, DC0V, fast connector R, S, T fast connector
2 kW ~ 7.5 kW DC24V, DC0V, terminal block R, S, T terminal block
Barcode A20421LT14130102
Firmware Version 01.34
DELTA ELECTRONICS, INC. MADE IN TAIWAN
Serial Number
Serial Number
A S D - A 2 - 0 7 4 3 - U
Model Type
Series
A2
Product Name
AC SERVO Drive
Model Type
NOTE A2-F
mode.
can only be controlled by DMCNET. It does not support any other operation
E C M A - C 1 0 6 0 2 E S
Standard Shaft Diameter: S
Specific Shaft Diameter: 3=42mm, 7=14mm
Encoder Type
1: Incremental, 20-bit
2: Incremental, 17-bit
3: 2500 ppr
Servo Type A: Absolute (Resolution of single cycle: 17-
A: AC Servo bit; Resolution of multi-cycle: 16-bit)
Product Name
ECM: Electronic
Commutation Motor
Single-
/Three- 750 ECMA-C△0807□S 5.10 15.30
phase ASD-A2-0721-□ 5.10 15.30
750 ECMA-C△0907□S 3.66 11.00
Max.
Max. Continuou Instanta
Rated
Motor Output Instantaneous s Output neous
Power Model Number Current Model Number
series (W) current Current output
(Arms)
(A) (Arms) current
(A)
ECMA-C/G 3000 r/min
ECMA-C△0807□H
High Inertia
NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names are for optional configurations. For the actual
model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product.
2) The boxes (△) in the model names are for encoder resolution types. △=1: Incremental type, 20-bit;
△=2: Incremental type, 17-bit; △=3: 2500 ppr; △=A: Absolute type). The listed motor model name is
for information searching, please contact to your local distributors for actual purchased product.
3) The boxes () in the model names represents brake or keyway oil seal.
4) *11kw and 15kW will be available soon.
The above table shows the specification of servo drive which has triple rated current. For detailed
specification of the servo motor and servo drive, please refer to Chapter 11.
ECMA-J△0907S ASD-A2-0743-□
Low Inertia
3000 r/min
Three-
900 ECMA-M△1309S 4.4 13.1 ASD-A2-1543-□ 5.02 10.04
phase
NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names are for optional configurations. For the actual
model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product.
2) The boxes (△) in the model names are for encoder resolution types. △=1: Incremental type, 20-bit;
△=2: Incremental type, 17-bit; △=3: 2500 ppr; △=A: Absolute type). The listed motor model name is
for information searching, please contact to your local distributors for actual purchased product.
3) The boxes () in the model names represents brake or keyway oil seal.
The above table shows the specification of servo drive which has triple rated current. For detailed
specification of the servo motor and servo drive, please refer to Chapter 11.
1.4 Eac
ch Part of
o the Servo Drive
e
1.4.1 220
0V Series
220V Serie
es - Front View
V
Revision Dece
ember 2014 1-9
9
ASDA-A2 Chapter 1 Inspeection and Mod
del Explanation
n
220V Serie
es - Top View
220V Serie
es - Bottom
m View
Revision Dece
ember 2014 1-11
ASDA-A2 Chapter 1 Inspeection and Mod
del Explanation
n
1.4.2 400
0V Series
400V Serie
es - Front View
400V Serie
es - Top View
Revision Dece
ember 2014 1-13
3
ASDA-A2 Chapter 1 Inspeection and Mod
del Explanation
n
400V Serie
es - Bottom
m View
2.1 Notes
Please pay special attention to the followings:
1) Do not strain the cable connection between the servo drive and the servo motor.
2) Make sure each screw is tightened when fixing the servo drive.
4) If the connection between the servo drive and the servo motor is over 20 meters, please
thicken the connecting wire, UVW as well as the encoder cable.
Store the product within a relative humidity range of 0% to 90% and a non-condensing
environment.
Avoid storing the product in the environment of corrosive gas and liquid.
It is better to store the product in shipping carton and put it on the shelf or working platform.
The ambient temperature of the motor is between 0℃ and 40℃ and the ambient conditions include:
Location has not water drop, vapor, dust and oily dust.
Scheme of Installation:
In order to have smaller wind resistance of the fan and increase the ventilation, please follow the
suggested clearance value when installing one or more than one servo drives. (Refer to the
following diagrams)
The above diagrams are not in equal proportion. Please refer to the
NOTE annotation.
The above diagrams are not in equal proportion. Please refer to the
NOTE annotation.
400V Series
Caution: Please use the fuse and circuit breaker that is recognized by UL/CSA.
Servo Drive Model Circuit Breaker Fuse (Class T)
Operation Mode General General
ASD-A2-0743- 10A 20A
ASD-A2-1043- 15A 25A
ASD-A2-1543- 20A 40A
ASD-A2-2043- 30A 50A
ASD-A2-3043- 30A 70A
ASD-A2-4543- 70A 140A
ASD-A2-5543- 75A 150A
ASD-A2-7543- 95A 175A
If the servo drive equips with earth leakage circuit breaker for avoiding electric
NOTE leakage, please choose the current sensitivity which is over 200mA and can
continue up to 0.1 seconds.
400V Series
Item Power Servo Drive Model Recommended EMI Filter FootPrint
1 750W ASD-A2-0743- RF007S43AA N
2 1000W ASD-A2-1043- RF007S43AA N
3 1500W ASD-A2-1543- RF022B43AA N
4 2000W ASD-A2-2043- RF037B43BA N
5 3000W ASD-A2-3043- RF037B43BA N
6 4500W ASD-A2-4543- RF075M43BA N
7 5500W ASD-A2-5543- RF075M43BA Y
8 7500W ASD-A2-7543- RF075M43BA Y
When installing servo drive and EMI Filter, please follow the instructions of the user manual and
make sure it meets the following specification.
1. EN61000-6-4 (2001)
General Precaution
In order to ensure the best performance of EMI Filter, apart from the instructions of servo drive
installation and wiring, please follow the precautions mention below:
1. The servo drive and EMI Filter should be installed on the same metal plate.
2. When installing servo drive and EMI Filter, the servo drive should be installed above the EMI
Filter.
5. The metal cover of the servo drive and EMI Filter or grounding should be firmly fixed on the
metal plate. Also, the contact area should be as large as possible.
1. Use the cable that has braid shielding (The effect of double shielding is better)
2. The shield on both sides of the motor cable should be grounded in the shortest distance and
the largest contact area.
3. The protective paint of the U-shape saddle and metal plate should be removed in order to
ensure the good contact. Please see figure 1.
4. It should have correct connection between the braid shielding of the motor cable and the
metal plate. The braid shielding on both sides of the motor cable should be fixed by the U-
shape saddle and metal plate. Please see figure 2 for the correct connection.
When the regenerative resistor exceeds the capacity of built-in regenerative resistor, the external
regenerative resistor should be applied. Please pay special attention to the followings when using
the regenerative resistor.
1. Please correctly set up the resistance (P1-52) and capacity (P1-53) of regenerative resistor.
Or it might influence the performance of this function.
2. If users desire to use the external regenerative resistor, please make sure the applied value
should not smaller than the built-in regenerative resistor. In general application, more than
one resistor will be serial connected. If the value (from serial connected resistors) exceeds
the setting range, users can reduce the value by parallel connecting the resistor. If users
desire to connect it in parallel to increase the power of regenerative resistor, please make
sure the capacitance meets the requirements.
Please refer to the followings for the calculation when serial / parallel connecting
regenerative resistors:
C
Setting:
P1-52=20 (Ω)
P1-53=2000 (W)
Setting:
P1-52=5 (Ω)
P1-53=2000 (W)
3. In natural environment, if the capacity of regenerative resistor (the average value) is within
the rated capacity, the temperature of the capacitance will increase to 120℃ or even higher
(under the condition of regenerative energy keeps existing). For safety concerns, please
apply the method of forced cooling in order to reduce the temperature of regenerative
resistor. Or, it is suggested to use the regenerative resistor which is equipped with thermal
switches. Please contact the distributors for load characteristics of the regenerative resistor.
When using the external regenerative resistor, the resistor should connect to P, C terminal and the
contact of P, D terminal should be opened. It is recommended to choose the above mentioned
capacitance. For easy calculation of regenerative resistor capacity, except the energy consumed
by IGBT, two ways are provided to select the capacity of external regenerative resistor according
to the selected linear motor or rotary motor.
Medium
1.5 ECMA-K△1315 11.18 55.29 57.41
Inertia
Assume that the load inertia is N times to the motor inertia and the motor decelerates from
3000r/min to 0, its regenerative energy is (N+1) x Eo. The consumed regenerative resistor is (N+1)
× Eo - Ec joule. If the cycle of back and forth operation is T sec, then the power of regenerative
resistor it needs is 2× ((N+1) x Eo - Ec) / T.
Followings are the calculation procedure:
Take 400W as the example, the cycle of back and forth operation is T = 0.4sec, the maximum
speed is 3000r/min and the load inertia is 7 times to the motor inertia. Then, the needful power of
regenerative resistor is 2 × ((7+1) × 1.68 – 8) / 0.4 = 27.2 W. If it is smaller than the built-in capacity
of regenerative resistor, the built-in 60W regenerative resistor will do. Generally speaking, when
the need of the external load inertia is not much, the built-in regenerative is enough. The diagram
below describes the actual operation. The smaller power of the regenerative resistor it is, the more
energy it accumulates and the higher temperature it will be. When the temperature is higher than a
specific value, ALE05 occurs.
(b) If the external load torque exists, the motor is in reverse rotation.
Usually, the motor is in forward rotation, which means the torque output direction of the motor
is the same as the rotation direction. However, in some applications, the direction of torque
output is different from the rotation. In this situation, the motor is in reverse rotation. The
external energy goes into the servo drive through the motor. The diagram below is one
example. When the external force direction is the same as the moving direction, the servo
system has to use the force of the opposite direction to keep the speed and stability. Huge
amount of energy will return to the servo drive at the moment. When DC-BUS is full and
unable to store the regenerative energy, the energy will be leaded to regenerative resistor
and consumed.
馬 達Speed
Motor 轉速
外External
部 負Load 載扭 矩
Torque
馬Motor
達輸 出扭
Output 矩
Torque
馬Negative
達輸出 負功
Torque
正功
Positive 負 功Torque
Negative 正功
Positive
Torque
Torque
Negative torque: TL × Wr TL: external load torque
For safety reasons, please calculate it by considering the safest situation.
For example, when the external load torque is the +70% rated torque and the rotation
reaches 3000 r/min, then take 400 W (the rated torque is 1.27 Nt-m) as the example, the
user has to connect the regenerative resistor of 40, which is 2 ×(0.7×1.27) ×(3000 ×2 ×π/
60) = 560W.
(2) Simple Selection
Choose the appropriate regenerative resistor according to the allowable frequency and
empty load frequency in actual operation. The so-called empty allowable frequency is the
frequency of continuous operation when the servo motor runs from 0r/min to the rated speed
and then decelerates from the rated speed to 0r/min within the shortest time. The following
table lists the allowable frequency when the servo drive runs without load (times/min).
Allowable frequency when the servo motor runs without load (times/min)
and uses a built-in regenerative resistor
Motor Capacity 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.0 3.0 4.5 5.5 7.5 11.0 15.0
600W 750W 900W
kW kW kW kW kW kW kW kW kW kW
Servo Motor 06 07 09 10 15 20 20 30 45 55 75 1B 1F
83
ECMAC - 312 - 137 - - - - - - - -
(F100)
24 10
ECMAE - - - 42 32 11 - - - - -
(F130) (F180)
ECMAF - - - - - - - 11 8 - - - -
ECMAG 42 - 31 - - - - - - - - - -
Allowable frequency when the servo motor runs without load (times/min)
and uses a built-in regenerative resistor
Motor Capacity 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.0 3.0 4.5 5.5 7.5 11.0 15.0
600W 750W 900W
kW kW kW kW kW kW kW kW kW kW
Servo Motor 06 07 09 10 15 20 20 30 45 55 75 1B 1F
ECMAJ - 537 - - - - - - - - - - -
ECMAK - - - 162 122 - - - - - - - -
ECMAL - - - - - - - - - - - - -
When the servo motor runs with load, the allowable frequency will be different according to
different load inertia or speed. The following is the calculation method.
m represents load / motor inertia ratio.
2
Allowable frequency when serv o motor run without load Rated s peed times
Allowable fr equency = x
m+1 Operating speed mi n.
The comparison table of external regenerative resistor is provided below. Please choose the
appropriate regenerative resistor according to the allowable frequency.
The table below describes the suggested allowable frequency (times/min) of regenerative
resistor when the servo drive runs without load.
Allowable frequency of regenerative resistor when the servo drive runs without load (times/min)
ECMAC
Motor Capacity
400W 400W
100W 200W 750W 1.0kW 2.0kW
(F60) (F80)
Corresponding Motor
01 02 04 04 07 10 20
BR400W040 (400W 40Ω) - - 8608 3506 2110 925 562
BR1K0W020 (1kW 20Ω) - - - 8765 5274 2312 1406
ECMAE
Motor Capacity
2.0kW 2.0kW
0.5kW 1kW 1.5kw 3.0kW
(F130) (F180)
Corresponding Motor
05 1.0 15 20 20 30
BR400W040 (400W 40Ω) 291 283 213 163 68 -
BR1K0W020 (1kW 20Ω) 729 708 533 408 171 -
BR1K5W005*2 (3kW 10Ω) - - - - - 331
Allowable frequency of regenerative resistor when the servo drive runs without load (times/min)
ECMAK
Motor Capacity
1.0kW 1.5kW 2.0kW
Corresponding Motor
10 15 20
BR400W040 (400W 40Ω) - 488 665
If watt is not enough when using regenerative resistor, connecting the same regenerative
resistor in parallel can increase the power.
This chapter provides information on wiring ASDA-A2 series products, the descriptions of I/O
signals and gives typical examples of wiring diagrams.
Electromagnetic
Contactor (MC)
Host Controller
Regenerative
Resistor (Option) It can connect to Delta PLC controller
P or other brands of NC controllers.
C P,D,C
Terminal Block Module (ASD-BM-50A)
The returned regenerative power generated L1c,L2c,Θ,R,S,T (Option)
when braking may result in damage. Thus,
external resistor is recommended. Connect Transmit the signal from CN1
the external resistor to P and C, and ensure 50pin to the controller via this
an open circuit between P and D. When block module.
applying internal resistor, ensure the circuit
is close between P and D, and the circuit is
open between P and C. CN1 I/O
Connector
CN5 Connector (Option)
Servo Motor
CN6 CANopen connector (Option) RJ45 connector. Please refer to section 3.9.
Extension digital input Extension DI connector. Please refer to section
CN7 connector (Option) 3.10.
2. Separate R, S, T and U, V, W from the other wires. The interval should be at least 30 cm
(11.8 inches).
3. If the wire of encoder CN2 or CN5 connecter is not long enough, please use shielded twisted-
pair cable which cannot exceed 20 meters (65.62 inches). If it exceeds 20 meters, please
choose the bigger wire diameter of signal cable to ensure it will not cause signal fading. As
for the encoder wiring specification of 20-meter-long cable, please use AWG26 of wire size
and metal braided shield twisted-pair cable which complies with the standard of UL 2464.
4. When using CANopen, please use the standard shielded twisted-pair cables to ensure the
communication quality.
6. Do not install the plug-in capacitance in servo drive. It might burn out the soft-start resistance
and danger will occur.
3.1.4 Spe
ecification
n of Motorr Power Ca
able
Te
erminal
Motor Model
M U, V, W / Connector of Brake
De
efinition
ECMA S (50W)
A-C1040F
S (100W)
A-C△0401
ECMA
S (200W)
A-C△0602
ECMA
S (400W)
A-C△0604
ECMA
H (400W)
A-C△0604
ECMA
A
7 (400W)
A-C△0804
ECMA
S (750W)
A-C△0807
ECMA
H (750W)
A-C△0807
ECMA HOU
USING: JOW
WLE (C420
01H00-2*2P
PA)
S (750W)
A-C△0907
ECMA
ECMA S (1000W
A-C△0910 W)
ECMA A-C1040F S (50W)
ECMA A-C△0401 S (100W)
ECMA A-C△0602 S (200W)
ECMA A-C△0604 S (400W)
ECMA A-C△0804 7 (400W) B
ECMA A-C△0807 S (750W)
ECMA A-C△0907 S (750W)
ECMA A-C△0910 S (1000WW)
HOU
USING: JOW
WLE (C420
01H00-2*3P
PA)
* : w
with brake
S (300W)
A-G△1303
ECMA
S (500W)
A-E△1305
ECMA
S (500W)
A-F△1305
ECMA
S (600W)
A-G△1306
ECMA
S (850W)
A-F△1308
ECMA
S (900W)
A-G△1309
ECMA
ECMA S (1000W
A-C△1010 W)
C
ECMA S (1000W
A-E△1310 W)
ECMA S (1300W
A-F△1313 W)
ECMA S (1500W
A-E△1315 W)
ECMA S (1800W
A-F△1318 W)
ECMA S (2000W
A-C△1020 W)
ECMA S (2000W
A-E△1320 W)
ECMA 4 (3000W
A-C△1330 W)
ECMA S (2000W
A-E△1820 W)
ECMA S (3000W
A-E△1830 W)
ECMA S (3000W
A-F△1830 W) D
ECMA S (3500W
A-E△1835 W)
ECMA S (4500W
A-F△1845 W)
Terminal
Motor Model U, V, W / Connector of Brake
Definition
ECMA-F△18553 (5500W)
ECMA-F△18753 (7500W) 32-17S
E
ECMA-F1221B3 (11kW) A D
ECMA-F1221FS (15kW) B C
3106A-32-17S
ECMA-F218553(5500W)
F
ECMA-F218753(7500W)
When selecting the wire rod, please choose 600V PVC cable and the length should not longer than
30m. If the length exceeds 30m, please take the received voltage into consideration when
selecting the wire size. Please refer to Section 3.1.6 for wire rod selection.
NOTE
1) No polarity for brake coil, the wiring name is BRAKE1 & BRAKE2.
2) Power for brake is DC24 V. Never share it with the power of control signal VDD.
3) Box, (△) in servo motor model represents encoder type. △=1: incremental, 20-bit; △=2:
incremental, 17-bit; △ = 3: 33-bit; △=A: absolute.
4) Box, () in servo motor model represents brake or keyway / oil seal.
NOTE This diagram shows the connection between the servo drive and the motor
encoder. It is not drawn by the practical scale and specification will be different
according to the selected servo drive and motor model.
1) Please refer to the Section of Specification and Definition of Encoder
Connector.
2) Please refer to Section 3.5 CN2 Connector.
NOTE This diagram shows the connection between the servo drive and the motor
encoder. It is not drawn by the practical scale and specification will be different
according to the selected servo drive and motor model.
Please refer to Section 3.5, CN2 Connector.
ECMA-F△1830S (3000W)
ECMA-E△1835S (3500W)
ECMA-F△1845S (4500W)
ECMA-F△18553 (5500W)
ECMA-F△18753 (7500W)
ECMA-F1221B3 (11kW)
ECMA-F1221FS (15kW)
Please select shielded multi-core and the shielded cable should connect to the SHIELD end.
Please refer to the description of Section 3.1.6.
NOTE 1) Box, (△) in servo motor model represents encoder type. △=1: incremental,
20-bit; △=2: incremental, 17-bit; △ = 3: 2500ppr; △ = A: absolute.
2) Box, () in servo motor model represents brake or keyway / oil seal.
ECMA-G△1309S
ASD-A2-1521- ECMA-E△1315S
ECMA-C△1020S 1.3 2.1 2.1 2.1
ECMA-E△1320S (AWG16) (AWG14) (AWG14) (AWG14)
ASD-A2-2023- ECMA-E△1820S
ECMA-F△1313S
ECMA-F△1318S
1.3 2.1 3.3 2.1
ECMA-C△1330S
(AWG16) (AWG14) (AWG12) (AWG14)
ECMA-E△1830S
ASD-A2-3023-
ECMA-E△1835S
ECMA-F△1830S
1.3 3.3 3.3
ASD-A2-4523- ECMA-F△1845S 8.4 (AWG8)
(AWG16) (AWG12) (AWG12)
1.3 3.3 13.3 3.3
ASD-A2-5523- ECMA-F△18553
(AWG16) (AWG12) (AWG6) (AWG12)
1.3 5.3 13.3 3.3
ASD-A2-7523- ECMA-F△18753
(AWG16) (AWG10) (AWG6) (AWG12)
2
Encoder Wiring - Wire Diameter mm (AWG)
Servo Drive Model
Size Number Specification Standard Length
ASD-A2-0121-
ASD-A2-0221-
ASD-A2-0421-
ASD-A2-0721-
ASD-A2-1021-
ASD-A2-1521-
ASD-A2-2023- 0.13 (AWG26) 10 core (4 pair) UL2464 3m (9.84ft.)
ASD-A2-3023-
ASD-A2-4523-
ASD-A2-5523-
ASD-A2-7523-
ASD-A2-1B23-
ASD-A2-1F23-
NOTE
1) Please use shielded twisted-pair cable for encoder wiring so as to reduce the interference of
the noise.
2) The shield should connect to the phase of SHIELD.
3) Please follow the Selection of Wire Rod when wiring in order to avoid the danger it may occur.
4) Box, () at the end of the servo drive model represents the model code of ASDA-A2. Please
refer to the model information of the product you purchased.
5) (△), in servo motor model represents encoder type. △=1: incremental type, 20-bit; △=2:
incremental type, 17, bit; △ = 3: 2500 ppr; △=A: absolute type.
6) Box, () in servo motor model represents brake or keyway / oil seal.
Power
Electromagnetic Power
Contactor (MC) DC24V±10%
If an alarm occurs, using ALARM
digital output can control
electromagnetic contactor and cut off
the power of the servo drive.
Host Controller
Servo Motor
Installation Notes:
1. Check if the power and wiring among R, S, T and DC24V, DC0V are correct.
Please refer to Chapter 11 for Specifications. Make sure the input voltage is correct, or it might
damage the servo drive or danger may occur.
2. Check if the output terminal U, V, W of the servo motor is correctly wired. The incorrect wiring
may disable the operation of the motor or cause the malfunction.
3. When applying to the external regenerative resistor, the contact between P and D should be
opened and the external regenerative resistor should connect to terminal P and C. When
applying to the internal regenerative resistor, the contact between P and D should be closed
and the contact between P and C should be opened.
4. When an alarm occurs or the system is in emergency stop status, use ALARM or WARN to
output and disconnect the power of magnetic contactor in order to disconnect the power of
servo drive.
1. When the power is cutoff, do not touch R, S, T and U, V, W since the capacitance inside the
servo drive still contains huge amount of electric charge. Wait until the charging light is off.
2. Separate R, S, T and U, V, W from the other wires. The interval should be at least 30 cm (11.8
inches).
3. If the wire of encoder CN2 or CN5 connecter is not long enough, please use shielded twisted-
pair cable which cannot exceed 20 meters (65.62 inches). If it exceeds 20 meters, please
choose the bigger wire diameter of signal cable to ensure it will not cause signal fading. As for
the encoder wiring specification of 20-meter-long cable, please use AWG26 of wire size and
metal braided shield twisted-pair cable which complies with the standard of UL 2464.
4. When using CANopen, please use the standard shielded twisted-pair cables to ensure the
communication quality.
6. Do not install the plug-in capacitance in servo drive. It might burn out the soft-start resistance
and danger will occur.
Wiring Method of Three-phase Power Supply (suitable for all series of 400 V servo drive)
3.2.4 Spe
ecification
n of Motorr Power Ca
able
Motor Mode
el U, V, W / Connector of Brake Terminal Definition
△0604S (400W)
ECMA-J△ (
△0807S (750W)
ECMA-J△ (
A
△0907S (750W)
ECMA-J△ (
△0910S (1000W)
ECMA-J△ (
HOU SING: MOL
LEX (39-01--2041)
△0604S (400W)
ECMA-J△ (
△0807S (750W)
ECMA-J△ (
△0907S (750W)
ECMA-J△ ( B
△0910S (1000W)
ECMA-J△ (
* : with brake
HOUS
SING:MOLEX (39-01-2061)
△1305S (5
ECMA-K△ 500W)
△1305S (5
ECMA-L△ 500W)
△1308S (8
ECMA-L△ 850W)
△1309S (900W)
ECMA-M△ (
△1010S (1
ECMA-J△ 1000W)
△1310S (1000W)
ECMA-K△ C
△1313S (1
ECMA-L△ 1300W)
△1315S (1500W)
ECMA-K△
△1020S (2
ECMA-J△ 2000W)
△1320S (2
ECMA-K△ 2000W)
△13304 (3
ECMA-J△ 3000W)
△1830S (3
ECMA-L△ 3000W)
△1845S (4
ECMA-L△ 4500W)
△18553 (5
ECMA-L△ 5500W) D
△18753 (7
ECMA-L△ 7500W)
△1820S (2
ECMA-K△ 2000W)
Wiring U V W CASE
C GROOUND B
BRAKE1 BRAKE2
Namme (Red) (Wh
hite) (Bl ack) (Green) (Y
Yellow) (Blue)
A 1 2 3 4 - -
B 1 2 4 5 3 6
C F I B E G H
D D E F G A B
Revision Dece
ember 2014 3-19
9
Chapter 3 Wiring ASDA-A2
When selecting the wire rod, please choose 600V PVC cable and the length should not longer than
30m. If the length exceeds 30m, please take the received voltage into consideration when
selecting the wire size. Please refer to Section 3.1.6 for wire rod selection.
NOTE
1) No polarity for brake coil, the wiring name is BRAKE1 & BRAKE2.
2) Power for brake is DC24 V. Never share it with the power of control signal VDD.
3) Box, (△) in servo motor model represents encoder type. △=1: incremental, 20-bit; △=2:
incremental, 17-bit; △=3: 2500 ppr; △=A: absolute.
4) Box, () in servo motor model represents brake or keyway / oil seal.
NOTE This diagram shows the connection between the servo drive and the motor
encoder. It is not drawn by the practical scale and specification will be different
according to the selected servo drive and motor model.
1) Please refer to the Section of Specification and Definition of Encoder
Connector.
2) Please refer to Section 3.5 CN2 Connector.
ECMA-J△0604S (400W)
ECMA-J△0807S (750W)
ECMA-J△0907S (750W)
ECMA-J△0910S (1000W)
NOTE This diagram shows the connection between the servo drive and the motor
encoder. It is not drawn by the practical scale and specification will be different
according to the selected servo drive and motor model.
Please refer to Section 3.5, CN2 Connector.
ECMA-K△1305S (500W)
Pin Terminal
ECMA-L△1305S (500W) Color
No. Identification
ECMA-L△1308S (850W)
A T+ Blue
ECMA-M△1309S (900W)
Blue&
ECMA-J△1010S (1000W) B T-
Black
ECMA-K△1310S (1000W) Red/Red
S DC+5V
ECMA-L△1313S (1300W) &White
Black/
ECMA-K△1315S (1500W) R GND Black&
ECMA-J△1020S (2000W) White
ECMA-K△1320S (2000W) BRAID
L –
SHIELD
ECMA-J△13304 (3000W)
Please select shielded multi-core and the shielded cable should connect to the SHIELD end.
Please refer to the description of Section 3.1.6.
NOTE 1) Box, (△) in servo motor model represents encoder type. △=1:
incremental, 20-bit; △=2: incremental, 17-bit; △=3: 2500 ppr; △=A:
absolute
2) Box, () in servo motor model represents brake or keyway / oil seal.
ECMA-L△1313S
ECMA-J△1020S
ASD-A2-2043- ECMA-K△1320S
ECMA-K△1820S
ECMA-L△1830S 1.3 1.3 1.3 2.1
ASD-A2-3043-
ECMA-J△13304 (AWG16) (AWG16) (AWG16) (AWG14)
2
Encoder Wiring - Wire Diameter mm (AWG)
Servo Drive Model
Size Number Specification Standard Length
ASD-A2-0743-
ASD-A2-1043-
ASD-A2-1543-
ASD-A2-2043-
0.13 (AWG26) 10 core (4 pair) UL2464 3m (9.84ft.)
ASD-A2-3043-
ASD-A2-4543-
ASD-A2-5543-
ASD-A2-7543-
NOTE
1) Box, () at the end of the servo drive model represents the model code of ASDA-A2. Please
refer to the model information of the product you purchased.
2) (△), in servo motor model represents encoder type. △=1: incremental type, 20-bit; △=2:
incremental type, 17, bit; △=3: 2500 ppr; △=A: absolute type.
3) Box, () in servo motor model represents brake or keyway / oil seal.
4) Please use shielded twisted-pair cable for encoder wiring so as to reduce the interference of
the noise.
5) The shield should connect to the phase of SHIELD.
6) Please follow the Selection of Wire Rod when wiring in order to avoid the danger it may occur.
Connect to external
Power regenerative resistor
_10%
_ 10%, DC24V +
3-phase 380~480V +
+12V
R
Rectifier Circuit
Phase Loss
Detection
Servo
S U
Regeneration
Motor
T
Circuit
V M
Encoder
DC24V ±15V
Control Power
DC24V
+5V
Power
Supply DC0V +3.3V
+24V GATE
Protection DRIVE
Circuit
Encoder Signal
A, B, Z Output Encoder
Signal CN2
Digital Output Processing
Analog Monitor
Linear Scale
Output
Display
A/D DSP CPLD
Data
Serial
Bus MODE SHIFT
Communication CN3 CN5
RS-232/RS-485 Full-Closed
CHARGE SET Loop
CN9 Reserved
In order to have a more flexible communication with the master, 5 programmable Digital Outputs
(DO) and 8 programmable Digital Inputs (DI) are provided. The setting of 8 digital inputs and 5
digital outputs of each axis are parameter P2-10~P2-17 and parameter P2-18~P2-22 respectively.
In addition, the differential output encoder signal, A+, A-, B+, B-, Z+ and Z-, input of analog torque
command, analog speed/position command and pulse position command are also provided. The
followings are the pin diagrams.
26 DO4- DO5+ DI8- DI6- DI3- SIGN HPulse /HSIGN V_REF GND HSIGN OCZ OZ 50
27 DO5- /HPulse DI7- DI5- PULLHI_S /SIGN PULLHI_P /PULSE PULSE COM- COM- COM- 49
1 DO4+ DO3+ DO2+ DO1+ DI1- COM+ GND MON2 VDD GND OA /OB OB 25
2 DO3- DO2- DO1- DI4- DI2- GND NC MON1 T_REF VCC /OA /OZ 24
NOTE NC means NO CONNECTION. This terminal is for internal use only. Do not
connect it, or it may damage the servo drive.
There are numerous operation mode of this servo drive (please refer to Chapter 6.1). Each
operation mode needs different I/O signal. In order to use the terminal in a more efficient way, the
selection of I/O signal has to be programmable. That is to say, users can choose the desired
DI/DO signal to meet the demand. Basically, the default setting of DI/DO signal has already have
the appropriate function which can satisfy the demand of normal application.
Users have to select the operation mode based on the needs first (please refer to Chapter 6.1 for
the introduction of each mode) and refer to the following DI/DO table to know the corresponding
default setting of DI/DO signal and Pin No of the selected mode in order to conduct the wiring.
The table below lists the default setting of DI/DO signal function and pin No:
The explanation of DO signal default setting is as the followings.
Pin Wiring
DO Signal Operation No. Method
Details
Name Mode (Refer to
+ - 3.4.3)
Pin Wiring
DO Signal Operation No. Method
Details
Name Mode (Refer to
+ - 3.4.3)
PT, PR,
PT-S, When the deviation between the motor command
TPOS PT-T, 1 26 and actual position (PULSE) is smaller than the
PR-S, setting value of parameter P1-54, this DO is ON.
PR-T
TQL N/A - - When torque is limiting, this DO is ON.
When the alarm occurs (except forward/reverse
ALRM ALL 28 27 limit, emergency stop, communication error, under
voltage), this DO is ON.
BRKR ALL - - Control contact of brake.
HOME ALL 3 2 When homing is completed, this DO is ON.
OLW ALL - - When the overload level is reached, this DO is ON.
A warning occurs.
WARN ALL - - When it is in the status of forward/reverse limit,
emergency stop, communication error, under
voltage, this DO is ON.
OVF ALL - - Position command overflows
SNL (SCWL) PR - - Reverse software limit
SPL
PR - - Forward software limit
(SCCWL) C5/C6/C7/
The output of internal position command is C8
Cmd_OK PR - -
completed.
CAP_OK PR - - CAPTURE procedure is completed.
When DO.Cmd_OK and TPOS are ON, this DO is
MC_OK PR - -
ON.
The master position of E-CAM is inside the setting
CAM_AREA PR - -
area.
When the deviation between the speed command
S_CMP S, Sz - - and the feedback speed of the motor is smaller than
the setting value of parameter P1-47, this DO is ON.
SDO_0 ALL - - Output the status of bit00 of P4-06
SDO_1 ALL - - Output the status of bit01 of P4-06
SDO_2 ALL - - Output the status of bit02 of P4-06
SDO_3 ALL - - Output the status of bit03 of P4-06
SDO_4 ALL - - Output the status of bit04 of P4-06
SDO_5 ALL - - Output the status of bit05 of P4-06
SDO_6 ALL - - Output the status of bit06 of P4-06
SDO_7 ALL - - Output the status of bit07 of P4-06
SDO_8 ALL - - Output the status of bit08 of P4-06
Pin Wiring
DO Signal Operation No. Method
Details
Name Mode (Refer to
+ - 3.4.3)
NOTE
1) For example, if the user selects PR mode, pin 3 and 2 are HOME. If the user selects S mode,
pin 3 and 2 are TSPD.
2) The unlisted Pin No means the signal is not the preset one. If users want to use it, parameters
need to be changed and set as the desired ones. Please refer to Section 3.4.4 for further
details.
Wiring
Pin
DI Signal Operation No. Method
Function
Name Mode (Refer to
3.4.3)
SPDLM T, Tz 10 ON means the speed limit command is effective.
STOP - - Stop
Wiring
Pin
DI Signal Operation No. Method
Function
Name Mode (Refer to
3.4.3)
It is contact B and has to be ON frequently; otherwise the
EMGS ALL 30
alarm (ALRM) will occur.
PT, PR, S, Reverse inhibit limit (contact B) and has to be ON
NL(CWL) 32
T, Sz, Tz frequently; or the alarm (ALRM) will occur.
PL PT, PR, S, Forward inhibit limit (contact B) and has to be ON
31
(CCWL) T, Sz, Tz frequently; or the alarm (ALRM) will occur.
PT, PR,
PT-S, Electronic gear ratio (numerator) selection 0 (Please refer
GNUM0 -
to P2-60~P2-62 for gear ratio selection (numerator).)
PR-S
PT, PR,
PT-S, Electronic gear ratio (numerator) selection 1 (Please refer
GNUM1 -
to P2-60~P2-62 for gear ratio selection (numerator).)
PR-S
In position mode, when this DI is ON, the external pulse
INHP PT, PT-S -
input command is not working.
The default setting of DI and DO in each operation mode is shown as the followings. Please note
that the following table neither detail the information as the previous one nor show the Pin number
of each signal. However, each operation mode is separated in different columns in order to avoid
the confusion.
ARST 0x02 Alarm Reset DI5 DI5 DI5 DI5 DI5 DI5
NL(CWL) 0x22 Reverse inhibit limit DI6 DI6 DI6 DI6 DI6 DI6
PL(CCWL) 0x23 Forward inhibit limit DI7 DI7 DI7 DI7 DI7 DI7
Original point of
ORGP 0x24
homing
SHOM 0x27 Homing is activated
CAM 0x36 E-Cam engaged
JOGU 0x37 Forward JOG input
JOGD 0x38 Reverse JOG input
Event trigger PR
command #1(refer to
EV1 0x39
the setting of P5-98,
P5-99)
Event trigger PR
command #2 (refer to
EV2 0x3A
the setting of P5-98,
P5-99)
Event trigger PR
command #3 firmware
EV3 0x3B
V1.008 sub04 will be
provided afterwards)
Event trigger PR
command #4 (firmware
EV4 0x3C
V1.008 sub04 will be
provided afterwards)
Electronic gear ratio
GNUM0 0x43
(numerator) selection 0
Electronic gear ratio
GNUM1 0x44
(numerator) selection 1
INHP 0x45 Pulse input inhibit
NOTE Please refer to Section 3.4.1 for corresponding pin from DI1 ~ 8.
NOTE Please refer to Section 3.4.1 for corresponding pin from DO1 to 5.
Pulse command can be input by the way of open-collector or Line driver. The maximum input pulse
of Line driver is 500 kpps and 200 kpps for open-collector.
C3-1: The source of pulse input is open-collector NPN equipment which applies the internal
power of the servo drive.
DC24V
VDD 17
Pull-hi_S 35
Approx.
1KΩ
The max. input pulse
frequency is 200 Kpps
51Ω
/SIGN 37 51Ω
Approx.
The max. input pulse
1KΩ
frequency is 200 Kpps
51Ω
/PULSE 41 51Ω
45
COM-
SG
C3-2: The source of pulse input is open-collector PNP equipment which applies the internal
power of the servo drive.
Caution: Do not apply to dual power or it may damage the servo drive.
C3-3: The source of pulse input is open-collector NPN equipment and applies the external
power.
Pull-hi_S 35
+ Approx.
DC24V 1KΩ The max. input pulse
- frequency is 200Kpps
51Ω
/SIGN 37 51Ω
/PULSE 41 51Ω
SG
Caution: Do not apply to dual power or it may damage the servo drive.
C3-4: The source of pulse input is open-collector PNP equipment and applies the external
power.
C4-1: Pulse input (Line driver) can only apply to 5V power. Do not apply to 24V power.
C4-2: High-speed pulse input (Line driver) can only apply to 5V power. Do not apply to
24V power.
The high-speed pulse input interface of the servo drive is not the isolated
interface. In order to reduce the interference of the noise, it is suggested
that the terminal ground of the controller and the servo drive should be
connected to each other.
When the drive connects to inductive load, the diode has to be installed. (The permissible current
is under 40mA. The surge current is under 100mA.)
C5: Wiring of DO signal. The servo drive applies to the internal power and the resistor is
general load.
C6: Wiring of DO signal. The servo drive applies to the internal power and the resistor is
inductive load.
C7: Wiring of DO signal. The servo drive applies to the external power and the resistor is
general load.
C8: Wiring of DO signal. The servo drive applies to the external power and the resistor is
inductive load.
C9: The wiring of DI. The servo drive applies to C10: The wiring of DI. The servo drive
the internal power. applies to the external power.
C11: The wiring of DI. The servo drive applies C12: The wiring of DI. The servo drive applies
to the internal power. to the external power.
Caution: Do not apply to dual power or it may damage the servo drive.
/OA 22
125Ω
OB 25
/OB 23
125Ω
OZ 50
/OZ 24
125Ω
SG
Corresponding Corresponding
Signal Name Pin No Signal Name Pin No
Parameter Parameter
DI1- CN1-9 P2-10 DO1+ CN1-7
P2-18
DI2- CN1-10 P2-11 DO1- CN1-6
DI3- CN1-34 P2-12 DO2+ CN1-5
P2-19
Standard DI4- CN1-8 P2-13 DO2- CN1-4
DI DI5- CN1-33 P2-14 Standard DO3+ CN1-3
P2-20
DI6- CN1-32 P2-15 DO DO3- CN1-2
DI7- CN1-31 P2-16 DO4+ CN1-1
P2-21
DI8- CN1-30 P2-17 DO4- CN1-26
EDI9 CN7-2 P2-36 DO5+ CN1-28
P2-22
EDI10 CN7-3 P2-37 DO5- CN1-27
Extension
EDI11 CN7-4 P2-38
DI
EDI12 CN7-5 P2-39
(optional)
EDI13 CN7-6 P2-40
EDI14 CN7-7 P2-41
J2 J1
PIN Description PIN Description
1 VDD 17 VDD
2 COM+ 11 COM+
3 COM- 2,4,6,26,45,47 COM-
4 DI1- 9 DI1-
5 DI2- 10 DI2-
6 DI3- 34 DI3-
7 DI4- 8 DI4-
8 DI7- 31 DI7-
9 DO1+ 7 DO1+
10 DO2+ 5 DO2+
11 PULL_HI_PS 35 PULL_HI_PS
12 /PULSE 41 /PULSE
13 PULSE 43 PULSE
14 /SIGN 37 /SIGN
15 SIGN 36 SIGN
16 OCZ 48 OCZ
17 GND 12,13,19,44 GND
J2 J1
PIN Description PIN Description
18 DO4+ 1 DO4+
19 DO3+ 3 DO3+
20 CN_GND 51,52 CN_GND
Example of wiring:
Wiring and
d installation
n of CN1 qu
uick connecctor:
Wiring
g:
Installation:
Revision Dece
ember 2014 3-53
3
Chapter 3 Wiring ASDA-A2
2
3.5 CN2
2 Conne
ector
The termin
nal block of the connec
ctor and pin number are
e as follows
s:
En
ncoder
CN2 Connector
C Con
nnector
Conne
ect to the Con
nnect to
CN2 on drive side the
e motor
servo
o drive
Quick
Connector
Military
Connector
(A) CN2 C
Connector
CN2 rear
view of the
Vieww from
thiss side
termiinal block
(B) Encod
der Connecctor
1 2 3 3 2 1
4 5 6 6 5 4
Quick 7 8 9 View fromm View from 9 8 7
Connector this side this side
HOUSING:AMP (1-172161-9)
Military
Connectorr B A M
C N L
P T
D K
R S
E J
F G H
3
3106A-20-29S
Term
minal Militarry Quuick
PIN No. Fu
unction and Description
n Color
Symmbol Connec ctor Connnector
ed / Red &
Re
14,16 +5
5V +5V powe
er supply S 7
White
ack / Black
Bla
13,15 GN
ND Power g
ground R 8
& White
Shell Shield
ding- Shield
ding L 9 -
About shie
elding and ground
g
The both ssides of CN2
2 encoder cable
c are C N2 connecttor and encoder conneector. Shield ding and
ground connductor shoould be corrrectly conneected to the correspond
ding pins soo as to effec
ctively
shield and ground.
ures of CN2
The shielding procedu 2 encoder cconnector arre as followings:
Revision Dece
ember 2014 3-55
5
Chapter 3 Wiring ASDA-A2
2
mplete a shielded
(6) Tighten the screws to com
CN2 connector.
6 5
4 3
2 1
CN3 Connector (female)
PIN N
No. Sig
gnal Name Term
minal Symbo
ol Function and Description
1 G
Grounding GND + 5 V connectss to the signal terminal
RS
S-232 data The drive rreceives the
e data
4 RS
S-232_RX
receiving The co
onnector coonnects to RS-232
R of PC
P
RSS-485 data The drive transmitts the date to differentiial
5 R
RS-485(+) terrminal (+)
tra
ansmission
RSS-485 data The drive transmitts the date to differentiial
6 R
RS-485(-) terrminal (-)
tra
ansmission
NO
OTE
1) Please refer to Ch
hapter 9, page 2 for the
e wiring of RS-485.
R
2) Two kinds of communication wire of IEE EE1394 are commercia ally availablee. One of th
he internal
ground
d terminals (Pin 1) will short circuiit with the shielding and
d will dama ge the drivee. Do not
connect GND to the
t shielding g.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 3-57
7
Chapter 3 Wiring ASDA-A2
Terminal
Pin No. Signal Name Function and Description
Symbol
1 /Z phase input Opt_/Z Linear scale /Z phase output
2 /B phase input Opt_/B Linear scale /B phase output
3 B phase input Opt_B Linear scale B phase output
4 A phase input Opt_A Linear scale A phase output
5 /A phase input Opt_/A Linear scale /A phase output
6 Encoder grounding GND Ground
7 Encoder grounding GND Ground
8 Encoder power +5V Linear scale 5V power
9 Z phase input Opt_Z Linear scale Z phase output
NOTE
1) It only supports AB phase signal and the encoder with 5 V.
2) Application of full-closed loop: It supports the encoder with highest resolution, 1280000 pulse
rev (Full-closed loop corresponds to the resolution of quadruple frequency when motor runs a
cycle.).
3.9 CN6
6 Conne
ector (CA
ANopen)
Based on tthe standarrd of CANop
pen DS301 and DS402
2, CN6 uses
s the standaard CAN intterface to
implement position, to
orque and speed
s mode
e. It also can
n read or monitor the ddrive status..
n number of
The station o CANopen
n is the sam
me as RS-2
232/RS-485. All are seet via param
meter P3-00
0
and the tra
ansmission rate can up
p to 1 Mbps.. It provides
s two sets of
o communiccation connectors, one
e
is for receiiving and an
nother one is for trans mission, in order to co
onnect moree than one drives. The
e
last servo d ects to termination resisstor.
drive conne
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
CN6 C
Connector (female)
(
P
PIN No. Sign
nal Name Function and Desccription
1, 9 CAN_H
C CAN_H
H bus line (dominant
( hhigh)
2, 10 CAN_L
C CAN_H
H bus line (dominant
( loow)
3, 11 CA
AN_GND Ground / 0 V / V -
4, 12 - Reserv
ved
5, 13 - Reserv
ved
6, 14 - Reserv
ved
7, 15 CA
AN_GND Ground / 0 V / V -
8, 16 - Reserv
ved
Revision Dece
ember 2014 3-61
Chapter 3 Wiring ASDA-A2
NOTE
1) The termination resistor is suggested to use 120 Ω (Ohm) 0.25W or above.
2) The wiring method of concatenate more than one drives is based on two terminals of
CANopen. One is for receiving and another one is for transmission. And the servo drive
connects to the termination resistor. The wiring diagram of the termination resistor is shown as
the followings:
*1 Caution: Do not use dual power supply or it might damage the servo drive.
Pin Definition:
Pin No Connector1 Connector2
1 BAT+ BAT+
2 BAT- BAT-
NOTE Due to the different design of servo drive model, CN8 might have one or two
connectors, which however has the same pin definition.
CCLR 4.7KΩ
2 EDI9-
DI2 10 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 3 EDI10-
TCM0 DI3 34 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 4 EDI11-
TCM1 DI4 8 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 5 EDI12-
ARST DI5 33 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 6 EDI13-
NL DI6 32 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 7 EDI14-
PL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
CN4
EMGS DI8 30
1 +5V DC *7
DO1+ 7
SRDY
1.5KΩ 2 Data-
DO1- 6
3 Data+
DO2+ 5 Please note:
ZSPD
1.5KΩ 4 GND
DO2- 4 *1 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring
24V CN5
DO3+ 3 diagrams in section 3.4.3.
HOME
1.5KΩ 8 +5V
DO3- 2 *2 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring
4 Opt A
DO4+ 1 diagrams in section 3.4.3.
TPOS
1.5KΩ 5 Opt /A
DO4- 26 *3 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
3 Opt B
DO5+ 28 diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode)
ALRM 1.5KΩ 2 Opt /B
DO5- 27 in section 3.4.3.
9 Opt Z
OA 21 *4 400W and below drives do not
A phase pulse 1 Opt /Z
/OA 22 provide built-in regenerative
6 GND
OB 25
B phase pulse 7 GND resistor.
/OB 23
Encoder CN6 CANopen *5 The coil of brake has no polarity.
Pulse OZ 50
Z phase pulse 1,9 CAN H *6 For extension digital inputs (DI)
Output /OZ 24
2,10 CAN L connections (CN7 is an optional
3,11 CAN GND part, not Delta standard supplied
Z phase open OCZ 48
collector
4,12 - part.).
GND 13
5,13 - *7 For USB connection. It is used to
Max. output
current 50mA 6,14 - connect to personal computer or
voltage 30V 7,15 CAN GND notebook.
8,16 - *8 Single -phase connections are for
servo drives 1.5kW and below only.
CN2 Encoder
5 T+ Blue
4 T- Blue/Black
7 - -
9 - -
Red/Red & SG Twisted-pair or
14,16 +5V White twisted-shield
Black/Black
10KΩ 13,15 GND & White
cable
CN1
CN3
±10V 10KΩ T-REF 18
10KΩ 6 RS485-
GND 13
5 RS485+
MON1 16
Twisted-pair or 10KΩ 4 RS232_RX
twisted-shield 10KΩ
GND 12,13,19
DC 24V 3 -
cable MON2 15
SG 2 RS232_TX
VDD 17
1 GND
COM+ 11
CN7
COM- 45,47,49 *1 *4
4.7KΩ
1 COM+
SON DI1 9 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ
2 EDI9-
CTRG DI2 10 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 3 EDI10-
POS0 DI3 34 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 4 EDI11-
POS1 DI4 8 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 5 EDI12-
ARST DI5 33 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 6 EDI13-
NL DI6 32 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 7 EDI14-
PL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
CN4
EMGS DI8 30 *5
1 +5V DC
DO1+ 7
SRDY
1.5KΩ 2 Data-
DO1- 6
3 Data+
DO2+ 5
ZSPD
1.5KΩ 4 GND
24V DO2- 4
CN5
DO3+ 3
HOME
1.5KΩ 8 +5V
DO3- 2
4 Opt A
DO4+ 1 Please note:
TPOS
1.5KΩ 5 Opt /A
DO4- 26 *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
3 Opt B
DO5+ 28 diagrams (SINK / SOURCE
ALRM 1.5KΩ 2 Opt /B
DO5- 27 mode) in section 3.4.3.
9 Opt Z
OA 21 *2 400W and below drives do not
A phase pulse 1 Opt /Z
/OA 22 provide built-in regenerative
6 GND
OB 25 resistor.
B phase pulse 7 GND
/OB 23 *3 The coil of brake has no
Encoder CN6 CANopen
Pulse OZ 50 polarity.
Z phase pulse 1,9 CAN H
Output /OZ 24 *4 For extension digital inputs (DI)
2,10 CAN L
3,11 CAN GND connections (CN7 is an
Z phase open OCZ 48
4,12 - optional part, not Delta
collector GND 13
5,13 - standard supplied part.).
Max. output 6,14 - *5 For USB connection. It is used
current 50mA
voltage 30V 7,15 CAN GND to connect to personal
8,16 - computer or notebook.
*6 Single -phase connections are
for servo drives 1.5kW and
below only.
Servo Drive
MCCB ASDA-A2 series
MC
AC 200/230 V R *2
P⊕
Three-phase*6 S Regenerative
50/60Hz D Resistor
T
C
Red
U
L1c White Power Supply
V
L2c Black
W
Green 24V EMGS BRKR Brake
*3
CN2 Encoder
5 T+ Blue
4 T- Blue/Black
7 - -
10KΩ 9 - -
CN1 Red/Red & SG Twisted-pair or
14,16 +5V White twisted-shield
±10V 10KΩ V-REF 42 Black/ Black &
10KΩ 13,15 GND White
cable
GND 44 10KΩ
CN3
±10V 10KΩ T-REF 18
10KΩ 6 RS485-
GND 13
5 RS485+
MON1 16
Twisted-pair or 10KΩ 4 RS232_RX
twisted-shield GND 12,13,19
cable
10KΩ DC 24V 3 -
MON2 15
SG 2 RS232_TX
VDD 17
1 GND
COM+ 11
CN7
COM- 45,47,49 *1 *4
4.7KΩ
1 COM+
SON DI1 9 4.7KΩ
2 EDI9-
TRQLM DI2 10 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 3 EDI10-
SPD0 DI3 34 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 4 EDI11-
SPD1 DI4 8 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 5 EDI12-
ARST DI5 33 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 6 EDI13-
CWL DI6 32 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 7 EDI14-
CCWL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
CN4
EMGS DI8 30
1 +5V DC *5
DO1+ 7
SRDY
1.5KΩ 2 Data-
DO1- 6
3 Data+
DO2+ 5
ZSPD
1.5KΩ 4 GND
24V DO2- 4
CN5
DO3+ 3 Please note:
TSPD
1.5KΩ 8 +5V
DO3- 2 *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
4 Opt A
DO4+ 1 diagrams (SINK / SOURCE
BRKR
1.5KΩ 5 Opt /A
DO4- 26
3 Opt B mode) in section 3.4.3.
DO5+ 28
ALRM 1.5KΩ 2 Opt /B *2 400W and below drives do not
DO5- 27
9 Opt Z provide built-in regenerative
OA 21
A phase pulse 1 Opt /Z resistor.
/OA 22
6 GND *3 The coil of brake has no polarity.
B phase pulse
OB 25
7 GND *4 For extension digital inputs (DI)
Encoder /OB 23
CN6 CANopen connections (CN7 is an optional
Pulse
Z phase pulse
OZ 50
Output 1,9 CAN H part, not Delta standard supplied
/OZ 24
2,10 CAN L part.).
3,11 CAN GND *5 For USB connection. It is used to
Z phase open OCZ 48
collector 4,12 - connect to personal computer or
GND 13
5,13 -
notebook.
Max. output 6,14 -
current 50mA *6 Single -phase connections are
voltage 30V 7,15 CAN GND
for servo drives 1.5kW and
8,16 -
below only.
Servo Drive
MCCB ASDA-A2 series
MC
AC 200/230 V R *2
P⊕
Three-phase *6 S Regenerative
50/60Hz D Resistor
T
C
Red
U
L1c White Power Supply
V
L2c Black
W
Green 24V EMGS BRKR Brake
*3
CN2 Encoder
5 T+ Blue
4 T- Blue/Black
7 - -
10KΩ 9 - -
CN1 Red/Red & SG Twisted-pair or
14,16 +5V White twisted-shield
±10V 10KΩ V-REF 42 Black/Black &
10KΩ 13,15 GND White
cable
GND 44 10KΩ
CN3
±10V 10KΩ T-REF 18
10KΩ 6 RS485-
GND 13
5 RS485+
MON1 16
Twisted-pair or 10KΩ 4 RS232_RX
twisted-shield GND 12,13,19
cable
10KΩ DC 24V 3 -
MON2 15
SG 2 RS232_TX
VDD 17
1 GND
COM+ 11
CN7
COM- 45,47,49 *1 *4
4.7KΩ
1 COM+
SON DI1 9 4.7KΩ
SPDLM 4.7KΩ
2 EDI9-
DI2 10 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 3 EDI10-
TCM0 DI3 34 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 4 EDI11-
TCM1 DI4 8 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 5 EDI12-
ARST DI5 33 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 6 EDI13-
CWL DI6 32 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 7 EDI14-
CCWL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
CN4
EMGS DI8 30 *5
1 +5V DC
DO1+ 7
SRDY
1.5KΩ 2 Data-
DO1- 6
3 Data+
DO2+ 5
ZSPD
1.5KΩ 4 GND
24V DO2- 4
CN5
DO3+ 3
TSPD
1.5KΩ 8 +5V Please note:
DO3- 2
4 Opt A *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
DO4+ 1
BRKR
1.5KΩ 5 Opt /A diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode)
DO4- 26
3 Opt B
DO5+ 28 in section 3.4.3.
ALRM 1.5KΩ 2 Opt /B
DO5- 27 *2 400W and below drives do not
9 Opt Z
OA 21 provide built-in regenerative
A phase pulse 1 Opt /Z
/OA 22 resistor.
6 GND
OB 25 *3 The coil of brake has no polarity.
B phase pulse 7 GND
Encoder /OB 23 *4 For extension digital inputs (DI)
CN6 CANopen
Pulse OZ 50 connections (CN7 is an optional
Output Z phase pulse 1,9 CAN H
/OZ 24 part, not Delta standard supplied
2,10 CAN L
3,11 CAN GND part.).
Z phase open OCZ 48 *5 For USB connection. It is used to
collector
4,12 -
GND 13
5,13 - connect to personal computer or
Max. output 6,14 - notebook.
current 50mA
voltage 30V 7,15 CAN GND *6 Single -phase connections are for
8,16 - servo drives 1.5kW and below
only.
Please note:
*1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode)
in section 3.4.4.
*2 400W and below drives do not
provide built-in regenerative
resistor.
*3 The coil of brake has no polarity.
*4 For USB connection. It is used to
connect to personal computer or
notebook.
*5 Single -phase connections are for
servo drives 1.5kW and below only.
*6 A2-F only supports DMCNET
mode.
2 EDI9-
CCLR DI2 10 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 3 EDI10-
TCM0 DI3 34 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 4 EDI11-
TCM1 DI4 8 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 5 EDI12-
ARST DI5 33 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 6 EDI13-
NL DI6 32 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 7 EDI14-
PL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
CN4
EMGS DI8 30
1 +5V DC *7
DO1+ 7
SRDY
1.5KΩ 2 Data-
DO1- 6
3 Data+
DO2+ 5
ZSPD
1.5KΩ 4 GND
24V DO2- 4
CN5
DO3+ 3
HOME
1.5KΩ 8 +5V
DO3- 2
4 Opt A
DO4+ 1
TPOS
1.5KΩ 5 Opt /A
DO4- 26 Please note:
3 Opt B
DO5+ 28 *1 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring
ALRM 1.5KΩ 2 Opt /B
DO5- 27 diagrams in section 3.4.3.
9 Opt Z
OA 21
A phase pulse 1 Opt /Z *2 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring
/OA 22
6 GND diagrams in section 3.4.3.
OB 25
B phase pulse 7 GND *3 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
Encoder /OB 23
Pulse CN6 CANopen diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode)
OZ 50
Output Z phase pulse 1,9 CAN H in section 3.4.3.
/OZ 24
2,10 CAN L *4 4.5kW and below drives provide
3,11 CAN GND built-in regenerative resistor.
Z phase open OCZ 48
collector
4,12 - *5 The coil of brake has no polarity.
GND 13
5,13 - *6 For extension digital inputs (DI)
Max. output
6,14 - connections (CN7 is an optional
current 50mA
Voltage 30V 7,15 CAN GND
part, not Delta standard supplied
8,16 -
part.).
*7 For USB connection. It is used to
connect to personal computer or
notebook.
CN2 Encoder
5 T+ Blue
4 T- Blue/Black
7 - -
9 - -
Red/Red & SG Twisted-pair or
14,16 +5V White twisted-shield
Black/Black & cable
10KΩ 13,15 GND White
CN1
CN3
±10V 10KΩ T-REF 18
10KΩ 6 RS485-
GND 13
5 RS485+
MON1 16
Twisted-pair or 10KΩ 4 RS232_RX
twisted-shield GND 12,13,19
cable
10KΩ DC 24V 3 -
MON2 15
SG 2 RS232_TX
VDD 17
1 GND
COM+ 11
CN7
COM- 45,47,49 *1
*4
4.7KΩ
1 COM+
SON DI1 9 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ
2 EDI9-
CTRG DI2 10 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 3 EDI10-
POS0 DI3 34 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 4 EDI11-
POS1 DI4 8 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 5 EDI12-
ARST DI5 33 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 6 EDI13-
NL DI6 32 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 7 EDI14-
PL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
CN4
EMGS DI8 30
1 +5V DC *5
DO1+ 7
SRDY
1.5KΩ 2 Data-
DO1- 6
3 Data+
DO2+ 5
ZSPD
1.5KΩ 4 GND
24V DO2- 4
CN5
DO3+ 3
HOME
1.5KΩ 8 +5V
DO3- 2
4 Opt A
DO4+ 1
TPOS
1.5KΩ 5 Opt /A
DO4- 26
3 Opt B
DO5+ 28
ALRM 1.5KΩ 2 Opt /B
DO5- 27
9 Opt Z
OA 21
A phase pulse 1 Opt /Z
/OA 22
6 GND
OB 25 Please note:
B phase pulse 7 GND
Encoder /OB 23 *1 Please refers to C9 ~ C12 wiring
CN6 CANopen
Pulse OZ 50
Output Z phase pulse 1,9 CAN H diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode)
/OZ 24 in section 3.4.3.
2,10 CAN L
3,11 CAN GND *2 4.5kW and below drives provide
Z phase open OCZ 48
4,12 - built-in regenerative resistor.
collector GND 13
5,13 - *3 The coil of brake has no polarity.
Max. output
6,14 - *4 For extension digital inputs (DI)
current 50mA
Voltage 30V 7,15 CAN GND connections (CN7 is an optional
8,16 - part, not Delta standard supplied
part.).
*5 For USB connection. It is used to
connect to personal computer or
notebook.
Servo Drive
MCCB ASDA-A2 series
MC
R *2
AC 380/480 V P⊕
Three-phase S Regenerative
D Resistor
T
C
Red
DC 24V U
24V White Power Supply
Power V
Supply 0V Black
W
Green 24V EMGS BRKR Brake
*3
CN2 Encoder
5 T+ Blue
4 T- Blue/Black
7 - -
10KΩ 9 - -
CN1 Red/Red & SG Twisted-pair or
14,16 +5V White twisted-shield
±10V 10KΩ V-REF 42 Black/Black &
10KΩ 13,15 GND cable
GND 44 10KΩ White
CN3
±10V 10KΩ T-REF 18
10KΩ 6 RS485-
GND 13
5 RS485+
Twisted-pair or 10KΩ MON1 16
4 RS232_RX
twisted-shield GND 12,13,19
cable 10KΩ DC 24V 3 -
MON2 15
SG 2 RS232_TX
VDD 17
1 GND
COM+ 11
CN7
COM- 45,47,49 *1 *4
4.7KΩ
1 COM+
SON DI1 9 4.7KΩ
TRQLM 4.7KΩ
2 EDI9-
DI2 10 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 3 EDI10-
SPD0 DI3 34 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 4 EDI11-
SPD1 DI4 8 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 5 EDI12-
ARST DI5 33 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 6 EDI13-
CWL DI6 32 4.7KΩ
4.7KΩ 7 EDI14-
CCWL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
CN4
EMGS DI8 30 *5
1 +5V DC
DO1+ 7
SRDY
1.5KΩ 2 Data-
DO1- 6
3 Data+
DO2+ 5
ZSPD
1.5KΩ 4 GND
24V DO2- 4
CN5
DO3+ 3
TSPD
1.5KΩ 8 +5V
DO3- 2
4 Opt A
DO4+ 1
BRKR
1.5KΩ 5 Opt /A
DO4- 26
3 Opt B
DO5+ 28
ALRM 1.5KΩ 2 Opt /B
DO5- 27
9 Opt Z
A phase pulse
OA 21
1 Opt /Z
/OA 22 Please note:
6 GND
B phase pulse OB 25 *1 Please refers to C9 ~ C12 wiring
7 GND
Encoder /OB 23 diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode)
CN6 CANopen
Pulse OZ 50
Z phase pulse 1,9 in section 3.4.3.
Output CAN H
/OZ 24 *2 4.5kW and below drives provide
2,10 CAN L
3,11 CAN GND built-in regenerative resistor.
Z phase open OCZ 48 *3 The coil of brake has no polarity.
collector 4,12 -
GND 13
5,13 - *4 For extension digital inputs (DI)
Max. output connections (CN7 is an optional
6,14 -
current 50mA
Voltage 30V 7,15 CAN GND part, not Delta standard supplied
8,16 - part.).
*5 For USB connection. It is used to
connect to personal computer or
notebook.
Please note:
*1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode)
in section 3.4.3.
*2 4.5kW and below drives provide
built-in regenerative resistor.
*3 The coil of brake has no polarity.
*4 For extension digital inputs (DI)
connections (CN7 is an optional
part, not Delta standard supplied
part.).
*5 For USB connection. It is used to
connect to personal computer or
notebook.
CN2 Encoder
5 T+ Blue
DC 24V
CN1 4 T- Blue/
Black Twisted-pair or
VDD 17 7 - - twisted-shield
COM+ 11 cable
9 - -
COM- 45,47,49
*1 14,16 +5V Red/Red& SG
4.7KΩ
White
Reserved DI1 9 13,15 GND Black/
Black&White
Reserved DI2 10 4.7KΩ
Reserved DI3 34
4.7KΩ CN4
1 +5V DC *4
Reserved DI4 8
4.7KΩ
ORGP DI5 33
4.7KΩ
2 Data-
NL DI6 32
4.7KΩ
3 Data+
PL DI7 31
4.7KΩ
4 GND
4.7KΩ
9 CAN H 9 DMCNET_1A
10 CAN L 10 DMCNET_1B
CN3
11 CAN GND 11 DMCNET_2A
RS485- 6
12 - 12 -
RS485+ 5 Data output
13 - 13 - Data output
RS232_RX 4
14 - 14 DMCNET_2B
- 3
15 CAN GND 15 -
RS232_TX 2
16 - 16 -
GND 1
Please note:
*1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring
diagrams (SINK / SOURCE
mode) in section 3.4.4.
*2 4.5kW and below drives provide
built-in regenerative resistor.
*3 The coil of brake has no
polarity.
*4 For USB connection. It is used
to connect to personal
computer or notebook.
*5 A2-F only supports DMCNET
mode.
Operation
This chapter details the panel status and operation of ADSA-A2 series servo drive.
Name Function
Five-/Seven-segment display is for displaying the monitoring values,
Display
parameter values and setting values.
Pressing SHIFT key can scrolls through parameter groups. After a
parameter is selected and its value displayed, pressing SHIFT key can
SHIFT Key
move the cursor to the left and then change parameter settings by using
arrow keys.
Pressing the SET key can display and save the parameter groups, the
various parameter settings. In monitor mode, pressing SET key can
SET Key
switch decimal or hexadecimal display. In parameter mode, pressing SET
key can enter into parameter setting mode.
Pressing the DOWN key can scroll through and change monitor codes,
DOWN Key
parameter groups and various parameter settings.
Pressing MODE key can enter or exit different parameter groups, and
MODE Key
switch between Monitor mode and Parameter mode.
Pressing the UP key can scroll through and change monitor codes,
UP Key
parameter groups and various parameter settings.
Charge LED The Charge LED lights to indicate the power is applied to the circuit.
Parameter Mode
Parameter
Mode
Monitor
‧‧‧
Parameter P0
SHIFT
Basic Parameter
‧‧‧
P1
SHIFT
Extension
‧‧‧
Parameter P2
SHIFT
Communication
‧‧‧
Parameter P3
SHIFT
Diagnosis
‧‧‧
Parameter P4
SHIFT
Motion Control
‧‧‧
Parameter P5
SHIFT
PR Parameter
‧‧‧
P6
SHIFT
PR Parameter
‧‧‧
P7
SHIFT
MODE
Monitoring Mode
Incorrect setting value or enter the reserved setting value. (Out of Range)
Parameter will be effective after the servo drive is re-powered on. (Power On)
High byte / low byte indication: When the data is displayed in decimal 32 bits,
it is for indicating the current high or low byte.
Negative sign: When the data is displayed in decimal format, the two
decimal points in the left represents the negative sign, no matter it is
showed in 16 or 32 bits. When it is showed in hexadecimal format, it only
shows positive sign.
(Dec high) If the value is 1234567890, the display of the high byte is
32 bits 1234.5 and displays 67890 as the low byte (shows in
decimal format).
(Dec low)
(Hex high) If the value is 0x12345678, the display of the high byte is
h1234 and displays L5678 as the low byte (shows in
hexadecimal format).
(Hex low)
Negative display. If the value is -12345, it displays 1.2.345 (only
shows in decimal format; there is no positive or negative sign for
hexadecimal format display).
NOTE
1) Dec means it is displayed in decimal format. Hex means it is displayed in hexadecimal format.
2) The above display methods can be applied in Monitor Mode and Editing Setting Mode.
3) When all monitor variables is 32 bits, high / low bit and the display (Dec/Hex) can be switched.
According to the definition in Chapter 8, each parameter only supports one displaying method and
cannot be switched.
SET
The 1st recent error
SET
The 2nd recent error
SET
The 3rd recent error
SET
The 4th recent error
SET
The 5th recent error
(1) Press the SET Key to display the speed value of JOG. The default value is 20r/min.
(2) Press UP or DOWN Key to adjust the desired speed value of JOG. It is adjusted to 100r/min
in the example.
(3) Press the SET Key to display JOG and enter JOG mode.
(4) When it is in JOG Mode, press UP or DOWN Key to enable the servo motor in forward or
reverse direction. The servo motor stops running as soon as the user stops pressing the key.
JOG operation is working only when it is Servo ON.
SET
SET
JOG Mode
P(CCW) N(CW)
MODE
Exit
NOTE
P4-06 is displayed in hexadecimal format. Therefore, it will not show the fifth 0.
For example, if it shows 3FE1, E is in hexadecimal format, it will be 1100 when it transfers to binary
format. Then, DI6~DI8 is ON.
SET
Binary code
DI DI DI DI DI DI DI DI DI DI DI DI DI DI Corresponding
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 DI status
(Display in hexadecimal format)
For example, if it shows 1F, F is in hexadecimal format, it will be 1111 when it transfers to binary
format. Then, DO1~DO4 is ON.
SET
Binary code
DO DODODODO Corresponding
5 4 3 2 1 DO status
(Display in hexadecimal format)
Tuning
This chapter is divided into two parts to describe the trial operation. The first one is the inspection
without load and another one is the inspection with load. For safety reasons, please conduct the
first inspection.
Inspection before running the servo drive (has already applied to the power)
The encoder cable should avoid excessive stress. When the motor is running, make sure the
cable is not frayed or over extended.
Please contact with Delta if there is any vibration of the servo motor or unusual noise during
the operation.
Make sure the setting of the parameters is correct. Different machinery has different
characteristic, please adjust the parameter according to the characteristic of each machinery.
Please reset the parameter when the servo drive is in SERVO OFF status, or it may cause
malfunction.
When the relay is operating, make sure it can work properly.
Check if the power indicator and LED display works normally.
PWM is used to control 7.5 kW. Thus, when the temperature is lower than 40℃, the fan does
not work.
A. Make sure the wiring between the motor and servo drive is correct.
1) U, V, W and FG have to connect to cable red, white, black and green respectively. If the
wiring is incorrect, the motor cannot work normally. The ground wire FG of the motor must
be connected to the ground terminal of the servo drive. Please refer to Chapter 3.1 and 3.2
for wiring.
2) The encoder cable of the motor has correctly connected to CN2: If users only desire to
execute JOG function, it is unnecessary to connect CN1 and CN3 (Please refer to Chapter
5.3). Refer to Chapter 3.1 and 3.5 for the wiring of CN2.
Caution: Do not connect the power terminal (R, S, T) to the output terminal (U, V, W) of the
servo drive. Or it might damage the servo drive.
Caution: Wiring of 220 V servo drive is different from 400 V. Make sure the wiring is correct,
or it might damage the servo drive.
220V Servo Drive: Apply power to the servo drive. Please refer to Chapter 3.1.3 for power wiring.
400V Servo Drive: Apply power to the servo drive. Please refer to Chapter 3.2.3 for power wiring.
C. Power on:
220V Servo Drive: Power of the servo drive: including control circuit (L1c, L2c) and main
circuit (R, S, T) power.
400V Servo Drive: Power of the servo drive: including control circuit (DC24V, DC0V) and
main circuit (R, S, T) power.
When the power is on, the display of the servo drive will be:
The digital input (DI6~DI8) of the default value is the signal of reverse limit error (NL), forward
limit error (PL) and emergency stop (EMGS), if not using the default setting of DI6~DI8,
adjusting the setting of P2-15~P2-17 is a must. Parameters could be set to 0 (disable this DI
When the screen displays no text, please check if the power of control circuit is under voltage.
1) When the screen displays:
Warning of overvoltage:
It means the voltage input by the main circuit is higher than the rated voltage or power
input error (incorrect power system).
Corrective action:
Use the voltmeter to measure if the input voltage from the main circuit is within the
range of rated voltage value.
Use the voltmeter to measure if the power system complies with the specification.
Corrective action:
If not desire to set positive limit (PL) as one of the digital input, make sure no digital
input is set to positive limit (PL) among DI1~DI8. (That is to say none of the
parameters, P2-10~P2-17 is set to 23.)
If the function of positive limit (PL) is needed and this DI is set as normally close
(function code: 0x0023), please make sure this DI is always normally close. If not,
please set this DI as normally open (function code: 0x0123).
NOTE
During the process of power on or servo on, if an alarm occurs or shows any abnormal display, please
contact the distributors.
Step 1:
Set the control mode of the servo drive to speed mode. Set P1-01 to 2 as speed mode. Then, re-
power on the servo drive.
Step 2:
In speed control mode, the digital input settings of trial run are as follows:
Digital Input Parameter Symbol Function Description CN1 Pin No
Setting Value
DI1 P2-10 = 101 SON Servo ON DI1- = 9
DI2 P2-11 = 109 TRQLM Torque limit DI2- = 10
DI3 P2-12 = 114 SPD0 Speed command selection DI3- = 34
DI4 P2-13 = 115 SPD1 Speed command selection DI4- = 8
DI5 P2-14 = 102 ARST Alarm reset DI5- = 33
DI6 P2-15 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function -
DI7 P2-16 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function -
DI8 P2-17 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function -
EDI9 P2-36 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 2
EDI10 P2-37 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 3
EDI11 P2-38 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 4
EDI12 P2-39 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 5
EDI13 P2-40 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 6
EDI14 P2-41 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 7
The above table disables the function of negative limit (DI6), positive limit (DI7) and emergency
stop (DI8). Thus, the value of parameter P2-15 ~ P2-17 and P2-36 ~ P2-41 are set to 0 (Disabled).
The digital input of Delta’s servo drive can be programmed by users. When programming digital
input, please refer to the description of DI code.
The default setting includes the function of negative limit, positive limit and emergency stop,
therefore, after the setting is completed, if there is any alarm occurs, please re-power on the servo
drive or switch ON DI5 to clear the alarm. Please refer to Chapter 5.2.
The speed command selection is determined by SPD0 and SPD1. See the table below.
Speed DI signal of CN1
Command Command Source Content Range
SPD1 SPD0
No.
S1 0 0 External analog Voltage deviation -10V ~ +10V
command between V-REF and GND
S2 0 1 P1-09 -60000 ~ 60000
Register
S3 1 0 P1-10 -60000 ~ 60000
parameter
S4 1 1 P1-11 -60000 ~ 60000
Register parameter
The parameter setting range is from -60000 to 60000. Setting speed = Setting range x unit (0.1
r/min).
For example: P1-09 = +30000; Setting speed = +30000 x 0.1 r/min = +3000 r/min
Step 3:
(1) Users switch ON DI1 and Servo ON.
(2) Both DI3 (SPD0) and DI4 (SPD1), the speed command, are OFF, which means it currently
executes S1 command. The motor rotates according to analog voltage command.
(3) When DI3 (SPD0) is ON, it means it currently executes S2 command (3000 r/min). The
rotation speed is 3000 r/min for rotary motor and 0.03 m/s for linear motor at the moment.
(4) When DI4 (SPD1) is ON, it means it currently executes S3 command (100 r/min). The
rotation speed is 100 r/min.
(5) When both DI3 (SPD0) and DI4 (SPD1) are ON, it means S4 command (-3000 r/min) is
executed at the moment. The rotation speed is -3000 r/min.
(7) If users desire to stop the motor, switch OFF DI1 (Servo OFF).
Step 1:
Set parameter P1-01 to 1, which is the position mode. Then, re-power on the servo drive.
Step 2: In position mode, the digital input settings of trial run are as follows:
Parameter
Digital Input Symbol Function Description CN1 Pin No
Setting Value
DI1 P2-10 = 101 SON Servo ON DI1- = 9
DI2 P2-11 = 108 CTRG Command triggered DI2- = 10
Position command
DI3 P2-12 = 111 POS0 DI3- = 34
selection
Position command
DI4 P2-13 = 112 POS1 DI4- = 8
selection
DI5 P2-14 = 102 ARST Alarm reset DI5- = 33
DI6 P2-15 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function -
DI7 P2-16 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function -
DI8 P2-17 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function -
EDI9 P2-36 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 2
EDI10 P2-37 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 3
EDI11 P2-38 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 4
EDI12 P2-39 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 5
EDI13 P2-40 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 6
EDI14 P2-41 = 0 Disabled Invalid DI function CN7 = 7
The above table disables the function of negative limit (DI6), positive limit (DI7) and emergency
stop (DI8), thus, set P2-15 ~ P2-17 and P2-36 ~ P2-41 to 0 (Disabled). The digital input of Delta’s
servo drive can be programmed by users. When programming digital input, please refer to the
description of DI code.
The default setting includes the function of negative limit, positive limit and emergency stop,
therefore, after the setting is completed, if there is any alarm occurs, please re-power on the servo
drive or switch ON DI5 to clear the alarm. Please refer to Chapter 5.2.
Please refer to Chapter 3.12.2, Position (PR) Mode Standard Wiring for wiring diagram. However,
since POS2 is not the default digital input, set P2-14 to 113. Please refer to the table below for 64
sets of register command, POS0~POS5 and the relative parameters.
Position Corresponding
POS5 POS4 POS3 POS2 POS1 POS0 CTRG
Command Parameter
P6-00
PR0 0 0 0 0 0 0
P6-01
P6-02
PR1 0 0 0 0 0 1
P6-03
~ ~
P6-98
PR50 1 1 0 0 1 0
P6-99
P7-00
PR51 1 1 0 0 1 1
P7-01
~ ~
P7-26
PR64 1 1 1 1 1 1
P7-27
Users can set the 64-set of command value (P6-00~P7-27). The value can be set as the absolute
position command.
3. Press the SHIFT Key twice to select the mode of parameter group.
5. Press the SET Key to display parameter value, which is shown as the
content on the right.
6. Press the SHIFT Key twice, then press the UP Key and then press the
SET Key.
7. Press the UP Key to select parameter P2-30.
11. Press the MODE Key and then press the DOWN Key to select the value of
inertia ratio.
12. The panel displays the current value of inertia ratio / total weight of
movable section and load (kg) (default value).
13. Press the MODE Key to select the mode of parameter function.
14. Press the SHIFT Key twice to select the mode of parameter group.
16. Press the SET Key to show the content, which is 20r/min at JOG speed.
Press the UP or DOWN Key to increase or decrease the JOG speed.
Press the SHIFT Key to move to the next digit of the left.
17. Set the desired JOG speed and press the SET Key which is shown as the
figure on the right.
18. Press the UP Key to rotate the motor in forward direction while press the DOWN Key the
motor will rotate in reverse direction.
19. Execute JOG operation at low speed first. With the constant speed, if the motor operates
smoothly in forward and reverse direction, users can execute JOG operation at higher speed.
20. In P4-05, the servo drive cannot display inertia ratio. Please press the MODE Key twice to
view the value of inertia ratio. If users desire to execute JOG operation again, press the
MODE Key, and then press the SET Key twice. Observe the panel display to see if the load
inertia ratio / total weight of movable section and load remain at the same value after
acceleration and deceleration.
Set P2-30 to 1.
No
Decrease the value of P2-00. Set Yes Mechanical
the value of P2-06 and P2-00 to system
the same. vibrates?
Yes
View the panel display to see if the inertia ratio remains the same after
alternately accelerate and decelerate. Then, select the tuning method
according to the inertia ratio.
Note: Users cannot view inertia ratio in JOG mode. Please press the
MODE Key twice. If users desire to perform JOG operation, press the
MODE Key, and then press the SET Key twice.
Adjust the value of P2-31: Increase the value of P2-31 to increase the response or decrease to
reduce the noise. Continue to tune until the performance is satisfied. Then, tuning is completed.
NOTE
1. If P2-33 bit 0 is set to 1, it means the inertia estimation in semi-auto mode is completed. The result can be
accessed by P1-37.
2. If the value of P2-33 bit 0 is cleared to 0, the system will start to estimate again.
In auto mode, the inertia value will be saved to P1-37 every 30 minutes; while in semi-auto mode,
the inertia value will be saved to P1-37 only until the system inertia is stable and stops the
estimation of load inertia.
NOTE
1. Parameter P2-44 and P2-46 are the setting value of resonance suppression. If the value has been set
to the maximum (32dB), and still cannot suppress the resonance, please reduce the speed bandwidth.
After setting P2-47, users can check the value of P2-44 and P2-46. If the value of P2-44 is not 0, it
means the resonance frequency exists in the system. Then, users can access P2-43 to see the
resonance frequency (Hz). When there is another resonance frequency, the information will be shown in
P2-45 and p2-46.
2. If resonance still exists, repeatedly set P2-47 to 1 for 3 times and manually adjust the setting of
resonance.
When switching mode from auto mode 1 to manual mode 0, the value of P1-37, P2-00, P2-04, P2-
06, P2-25, P2-26 and P2-49 will be modified to the one in auto mode.
When switching mode from semi-auto mode 2 to manual mode 0, the value of P1-37, P2-00, P2-04,
P2-06, P2-25, P2-26 and P2-49 will be modified to the one in semi-auto mode.
This parameter determines the response of position loop. The bigger KPP value will cause the
higher response frequency of position loop. And it will cause better following error, smaller
position error, and shorter settling time. However, if the value is set too big, the machinery will
vibrate or overshoot when positioning. The calculation of position loop frequency response is
as the following:
Position Loop Frequency Response Hz
This parameter determines the response of speed loop. The bigger KVP value will cause the
higher response frequency of speed loop and better following error. However, if the value is
set too big, it would easily cause machinery resonance. The response frequency of speed loop
must be 4~6 times higher than the response frequency of position loop. Otherwise, the
machinery might vibrate or overshoot when positioning. The calculation of speed loop
frequency response is as the following:
/
Speed Loop Frequency Response fv Hz
/
JM: Motor Inertia; JL: Load Inertia; P1-37: 0.1 times
When P1-37 (estimation or setting) equals the real inertia ratio (JL/JM), the real speed loop
frequency response will be: fv Hz
The higher the KVI value is, the better capability of eliminating the deviation will be. However,
if the value is set too big, it might easily cause the vibration of machinery. It is suggested to set
the value as the following:
KVI P2 06 1.5 Speed Loop Frequency Response
The high value of inertia ratio will reduce the frequency response of speed loop. Therefore, the
KVP value must be increased to maintain the response frequency. During the process of
increasing KVP value, it might cause machinary resonance. Please use this parameter to
elimiate the noise of resonance. The bigger the value is, the better the capability of improving
high-frequency noise will be. However, if the value is set too big, it would cause the unstability
of speed loop and overshoot. It is suggested to set the value as the following:
NLP P2 25
This parameter is used to strengthen the ability of resisting external force and gradually
eliminate overshoot during acceleration / deceleration. Its default value is 0. It is suggested not
to adjust the value in manual mode, unless it is for fine-tuning.
It can reduce the position error and shorten the settling time. However, if the value is set too
big, it might cause overshoot. If the setting of e-gear ratio is bigger than 10, it might cause the
noise as well.
Operation
Short Setting
Mode Name Description
Name Code
PT-S 06 Switch the mode of PT and S via DI signal.
PT-T 07 Switch the mode of PT and T via DI signal.
PR-S 08 Switch the mode of PR and S via DI signal.
PR-T 09 Switch the mode of PR and T via DI signal.
Dual Mode
S-T 0A Switch the mode of S and T via DI signal.
CANopen 0B Control by the master
Reserved 0C Reserved
PT-PR 0D Switch the mode of PT and PR via DI signal.
PT-PR-S 0E Switch the mode of PT, PR and S via DI signal.
Multi Mode
PT-PR-T 0F Switch the mode of PT, PR and T via DI signal.
The following sections describe the operation of each control mode, including control structure,
command source and loop gain adjustment, etc.
6.2 Pos
sition Mo
ode
6.2.1 Pos
sition Com
mmand in PT Mode
PT, positio
on comman al block. There are thre
nd is the pulse input frrom termina ree types off pulse and
d
e/negative logic which can be set in parameter P1-00. S
each type has positive See as the fo
ollowings.
Ad
ddress: 010
00H
P1-00▲
▲ PTT
T External Pulse Input Type
e
01
101H
Parameter Reelated Section:
Parameter for in
ndividual axis
Attrib
bute: Seection 6.2.1
Operaational
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0x2
Defa
Con
ntrol
PT
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: 0 ~ 1132
Ran
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Pulse Type
0: AB
A phase pulse
p (4x)
1: Clockwise (CW)
( and C
Counterclockwise (CCW
W) pulse
2: Pulse + symmbol
O
Other settin
ngs: reserve
ed
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-3
3
Chapter 6 Control Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
Filter Width
If the received frequency is much higher than the setting, it will be regarded as
the noise and filtered out.
Setting Low-speed filter frequency Setting High-speed filter frequency
Value (Min. pulse width*note1) Value (Min. pulse width*note1)
0 0.83Mpps (600ns) 0 3.33Mpps (150ns)
1 208Kpps (2.4us) 1 0.83Mpps (600ns)
2 104Kpps (4.8us) 2 416Kpps (1.2us)
3 52Kpps (9.6us) 3 208Kpps (2.4us)
4 No filter function 4 No filter function
NOTE 1) When the source of external pulse is from the high-speed differential signal and
the setting value is 0 (the high-speed filter frequency is 3.33Mpps at the moment),
then:
If the user uses 2~4MHz input pulse, it is suggested to set the filter value to 4.
Note: When the signal is the high-speed pulse specification of 4 Mpps and the
settings value of the filter is 4, then the pulse will not be filtered.
Logic Type
Logic Pulse Type Forward Reverse
AB phase
pulse
Positive Logic
0 CW and
CCW pulse
Pulse +
Symbol
AB phase
pulse
Negative Logic
Pulse
T2 T2 T2 T3 T2 T2 T2 TH
1 CW and
CCW pulse Sign
Pulse +
Symbol
Position pulse can be input from CN1 terminal, PULSE (43), /PULSE (41), HPULSE (38),
/HPULSE (29) and SIGN (36), /SIGN (37), HSIGN (46), /HSIGN (40). It could be open-collector
or Line Driver. Please refer to Chapter 3.9.1 for wiring method.
Position
POS5 POS4 POS3 POS2 POS1 POS0 CTRG Parameters
Command
P6-00
P1 ON ON ON ON ON ON
P6-01
P6-02
P2 ON ON ON ON ON OFF
P6-03
~ ~
P6-98
P50 OFF OFF ON ON OFF ON
P6-99
P7-00
P51 OFF OFF ON ON OFF OFF
P7-01
~ ~
P7-26
P64 OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF
P7-27
The application of absolute type and incremental type register is rather extensive. It is more like a
simple procedure control. Users can complete the cyclic operation by referring to the above table.
For example, position command P1 is 10 turns and P2 is 20 turns. P1 is issued first and P2 comes
after. The following diagram shows the difference of both.
20 turns
20 turns
10 turns 10 turns
For a better control, the pulse signal should be processed and modified through position command
unit. Structure is shown as the diagram below.
The upper path of the above diagram is PR mode and the lower one is PT mode which could be
selected via P1-01. Both modes can set E-gear ratio for the proper position resolution. Moreover,
either S-curve filter or low-pass filter can be used to smooth the command. See the description in
later parts.
INHP
ON OFF ON
Pulse
command
Relevant Parameters:
Address: 0144H
P1-34 TACC Acceleration Constant of S-Curve
0145H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.3
Default: 200
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
NOTE 1)When the source of speed command is analog, and P1-36 is set to
0, it will disable S-curve function.
2)When the source of speed command is analog, the max. range of
P1-34 will be set within 20000 automatically.
Address: 0146H
P1-35 TDEC Deceleration Constant of S-Curve
0147H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.3
Default: 200
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
ngs: Dece
Settin eleration Co onstant of Rotary
R Motorr:
The time
t that sppeed comma and decelerrates from tthe rated sp peed to 0.
Deceeleration Co onstant of Liinear Motorr:
The time
t that sppeed comma and decelerrates from 55m/s to 0.
P1-344, P1-35 an nd P1-36, th he deceleration time off speed com mmand
from the rated s peed to zerro, all can be set individdually. Even n when P1-
36 is set to 0, it sstill has acc
celeration / deceleratioon of trapezo
oid-curve.
NO
OTE 1)W
When the so
ource of spe
eed command is analogg, and P1-3
36 is set to
0, it will disab
ble S-curve
e function.
When the so
2)W ource of speeed command is analogg, the max. range of
P1-35
P will be
e set within 20000 auto
omatically.
Accelera
ation / Dec
celeration Constant
C off S- Ad
ddress: 014
48H
P1-36 TSL
Curve 01
149H
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 6.33.3
ault: 0
Defa
Control
S, PR
R
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: ms
nge: 0 ~ 65500
Ran 6 (0: dissable this fu
unction)
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
ngs: Acce
Settin eleration / D eceleration Constant of
o S-Curve:
P1-34
4: Set the a
acceleration
n time of acc
celeration / deceleratio
on of
trapezoid
d-curve
P1-35
5: Set the d
deceleration
n time of acc
celeration / deceleratio
on of
trapezoid
d-curve
6: Set the ssmoothing tiime of S-curve accelerration and
P1-36
decelerattion
P1-344, P1-35 an nd P1-36 can
c be set individually . Even whe en P1-36 iss
set to
o 0, it still ha
as accelera
ation / deceleration of trrapezoid-cu
urve.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-11
Chapter 6 Control Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
NOTE 1)When the source of speed command is analog, and P1-36 is set to
0, it will disable S-curve function.
2)When the source of speed command is analog, the max. range of
P1-36 will be set within 10000 automatically.
Default: 1
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
29
Range: 1 ~ (2 -1)
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to P2-60~P2-62 for the setting of multiple gear ratio
(numerator).
NOTE 1. In PT mode, the setting value can be changed when Servo ON.
2. In PR mode, the setting value can be changed when Servo OFF.
Address: 015AH
P1-45 GR2 Gear Ratio (Denominator) (M)
015BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.5
Default: 1
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
31
Range: 1 ~ (2 -1)
Format: DEC
ngs: If the
Settin e setting i s wrong, the
t servo motor will easily have sudden
n
unintended acceeleration.
Pleas
se follow the
e rules for setting:
s
The setting
s of pu
ulse input:
Puulse Position
inp
put N command d N
f2 = f1 x
f1
1 M f2 M
NO
OTE 1) The
T setting value cann
not be chang
ged when S
Servo ON ne
either in
PT
P nor in PR
R mode.
Electronnic gear provvides simple ratio chan el distance. The high ellectronic ge
nge of trave ear ratio
would ca ause the po
osition comm mand to be the stepped command d. S-curve oor low-pass filter can
be used to improve on. When e lectronic ge
e the situatio ear ratio is set
s to 1, thee motor will turn
t one
cycle forr every 10000PUU. Wh hen electron
nic gear ratio is changeed to 0.5, thhen every tw
wo pulses
from thee command will be refe er to one PUUU of motorr encoder.
For exammple (rotaryy motor): after setting tthe electron o properly, tthe moving distance
nic gear ratio
of the ob
bject is 1μm
m/pulse, whiich is easie r to use.
WL: Working
W Loa
ad
Ball Sccrew
Motor (Encoder reso
olution: A/B
B, Z)
Gear Ratio
o Moving distance
e of each puulse comma
and
Electronicc gear is 1 3 1000 00
300
unappplied. m
1 4 2500 10000
Electronicc gear is 10000
applied. 1m
3000
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-13
3
Chapter 6 Control Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
Default: 0
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: 10 ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Example: 11 = 110 ms
Settings: 0: Disabled
Position
Time (ms)
PF LT
6.2.7 Tim
ming Diagrram in Pos
sition Mod
de (PR)
In PR mod de, the possition commmand is seleected by either DI sign nal (POS0~ ~POS5 and d CTRG) off
CN1 or co ommunicatio on. Please refer to Seection 6.2.2
2 for the infformation a bout DI sig
gnal and itss
egister. Followings are the timing d
selected re diagrams.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-15
5
Chapter 6 Control Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
fv
The position loop bandwidth cannot exceed the speed loop bandwidth. It is suggested that fp .
4
fv: response bandwidth of speed loop (Hz).
KPP = 2 × × fp. fp: response bandwidth of position loop (Hz).
Related parameters:
Address: 0200H
P2-00 KPP Position Loop Gain
0201H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.8
Default: 35
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: rad/s
Range: 0 ~ 2047
Format: DEC
Settings: When the value of position loop gain is increased, the position
response can be enhanced and the position error can be reduced. If
the value is set too big, it may easily cause vibration and noise.
Address: 0204H
P2-02 PFG Position Feed Forward Gain
0205H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.8
Default: 50
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: %
nge: 0 ~ 100
Ran
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
Settin e position co
ngs: If the ommand is changed sm moothly, inccreasing the
e gain
valuee can reducce the position error.
If the ommand is not changed smoothlyy, decreasing the gain
e position co
valuee can tacklee the problem of mechaanical vibrattion.
Position Control
Smoo
oth Constant of
o
Position
P Feed
Po
osition Feed
Differen
ntiator Forward
F Gain
Fo
orward Gain
P2-02
P2-03
Position Lo
oop
+ +
Gain Max. Spee
ed Limit
+
P2-00 P1-5
55
- S
Switching Ratte of
P
Position Loop Gain
P2-01 Gain Switching
P2-27 Spe
eed
+ Comm
mand
Possition
Encoder
Couunter
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-17
7
Chapter 6 Co
ontrol Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
2
6.2.9 Low
w-frequency Vibration Supprression in Position Mode
M
If the stiffness is not enough,
e the mechanica
al transmiss
sion will con
ntinue to vibbrate even when
w the
motor stop
ps after com
mpleting the positioning
g command.. The functio
on of low-fre
requency vib
bration
suppressio
on can elimiinate the vib
bration of m
mechanical transmissio
t n. The rangge is betwee
en 1.0Hz
and 100.0H
HZ. Both manual settin
ng and auto
o setting are
e provided.
Auto settin
ng:
If the frequ
uency is harrd to find, it can enable
e the functio
on of auto lo
ow-frequenccy vibration
on. This function autom
suppressio matically sea
arches the frequency
f o low-frequeency vibration. If P1-
of
29 is set to
o 1, the systtem will disa
able the fun
nction of low
w-frequency
y vibration ssuppression
n
automatica
ally and starrts to search the vibrattion frequen
ncy. When the detectedd frequency
y remains
at the same level, P1--29 will be set
s to 0 auto
omatically and
a set the first
f frequenncy in P1-25
5 and set
P1-26 to 1. The secon
nd frequenc
cy will be se
et in P1-27 and
a then se
et P1-28 to 11. If P1-29 is
automatica
ally set backk to 0 and still
s has low--frequency vibration,
v please checkk if the func
ction of P1-
26 or P1-2
28 is enabled. If the value of P1-26 8 is 0, it means no freqquency has been
6 and P1-28
detected. P
Please decrrease the va
alue of P1-3
30 and set P1-29 to 1 so
s as to seaarch the vib
bration
frequency again. Plea at when the detection le
ase note tha evel is set too small, thhe noise will be
regarded a
as the low-frrequency.
Note 1: When the value of P1-26 and P1-28 is 0, it means it is unable to search the frequency. It is
probably because the detection level is set too high and is unable to detect the low-frequency
vibration.
Note 2: When the value of P1-26 or P1-28 is not set to 0 and still cannot eliminate the vibration, it
is probably because the detection level is set too low, the system regards the noise or other non-
primary frequency as the low-frequency vibration.
Note 3: When the process of auto vibration suppression is completed and the vibration still cannot
be diminished, P1-25 or P1-27 can be manually set to suppress the vibration if the frequency (Hz)
of the low-frequency is identified.
Related parameters:
Auto Low-frequency Vibration Supression Address: 013AH
P1-29 AVSM
Setting 013BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 0
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 1
Format: DEC
Address: 013CH
P1-30 VCL Low-frequency Vibration Detection
013DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 500
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
Range: 1 ~ 8000
Format: DEC
Settings: When enabling the auto suppression (P1-29 = 1), it will automatically
search the detection level. The lower the value is, the more sensitive
the detection will be. However, it is easy to misjudge the noise or
regard the other low-frequency vibration as the suppression frequency.
If the value is bigger, it will make more precise judgment. However, if
the vibration of the mechanism is smaller, it might not detect the
frequency of low-frequency vibration.
P1-30 is to set the range to detect the magnitude of low-frequency vibration. When the
frequency is not being detected, it is probably because the value of P1-30 is set too big which
exceeds the range of vibration. It is suggested to decrease the value of P1-30. Please note that
if the value is too small, the system might regard the noise as the vibration frequency. If the
SCOPE is available, it can be used to observe the range of position error (pulse) between upper
and lower magnitude of the curve and set up the appropriate value of P1-30.
Manual Setting:
There are two sets of low-frequency vibration suppression. One is parameter P1-25~P1-26 and
another one is parameter P1-27~P1-28. These two sets of low-frequency vibration suppression
can be used to eliminate two different frequency vibrations. Parameter P1-25 and P1-27 are
used to suppress the low-frequency vibration. The function is working only when the parameter
setting value of low-frequency vibration close to the real vibration frequency. Parameter P1-26
and P1-28 are used to set the response after filter. The bigger the setting value of P1-26 and P1-
28 is, the better response will be. However, if the value is set too big, the motor might not
operate smoothly. The default value of parameter P1-26 and P1-28 is 0, which means the
function is disabled. Followings are the related parameters:
Address: 0132H
P1-25 VSF1 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (1)
0133H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 1000
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: 0.1 Hz
Range: 10 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Example: 150= 15 Hz
Settings: The setting value of the first low-frequency vibration suppression. If P1-
26 is set to 0, then it will disable the first low-frequency filter.
Default: 0
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The first low-frequency vibration suppression gain. The bigger value it
is, the better the position response will be. However, if the value is set
too big, the motor will not be able to smoothly operate. It is suggested
to set the value to 1.
Address: 0136H
P1-27 VSF2 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (2)
0137H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 1000
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: 0.1 Hz
Range: 10 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Example: 150 = 15 Hz
Address: 0138H
P1-28 VSG2 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (2)
0139H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 0
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The second low-frequency vibration suppression gain. The bigger value
it is, the better the position response will be. However, if the value is set
too big, the motor will not be able to smoothly operate. It is suggested to
set the value to 1.
There are two types of speed command source, analog voltage and internal parameters. The
selection is determined by CN1 DI signal. See as the followings.
When both SPD0 and SPD1 are 0, if it is in Sz mode, the command will be 0. Thus, if there
is no need to use analog voltage as the speed command, Sz mode can be applied to tackle
the problem of zero-drift. If it is in S mode, the command will be the voltage deviation
between V-REF and GND. The range of input voltage is between -10V and +10V and its
corresponding speed is adjustable (P1-40).
When one of SPD0 and SPD1 is not 0, the speed command is from the internal parameter.
The command is activated after changing the status of SPD0~SPD1. There is no need to
use CTRG for triggering.
The setting range of internal parameters is between -60000 and 60000. Setting value =
setting range x unit (0.1r/min).
The speed command not only can be issued in speed mode (S or Sz), but also in torque mode
(T or Tz) as the speed limit.
Speed Command
Speed
Command
Processing
Speed
Estimator
Resonance Current
Speed control Torque Limit Motor
Suppression Loop
The speed command unit is to select speed command source according to Section 6.3.1, including
the scaling (P1-40) setting and S-curve setting. The speed control unit manages the gain
parameters of the servo drive and calculates the current command for servo motor in time. The
resonance suppression unit is to suppress the resonance of mechanism. Detailed descriptions are
shown as the following:
Here firstly introduces the function of speed command unit. Its structure is as the following diagram.
Analog signal
The upper path is the command from register while the lower one is external analog command.
The command is selected according to the status of SPD0, SPD1 and P1-01(S or Sz). Usually, S-
curve and low-pass filter are applied for having a smooth resonance of command.
Related parameters:
Address: 0144H
P1-34 TACC Acceleration Constant of S-Curve
0145H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.3
Default: 200
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
NOTE 1)When the source of speed command is analog, and P1-36 is set to
0, it will disable S-curve function.
2)When the source of speed command is analog, the max. range of
P1-34 will be set within 20000 automatically.
Address: 0146H
P1-35 TDEC Deceleration Constant of S-Curve
0147H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.3
Default: 200
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
NOTE 1)When the source of speed command is analog, and P1-36 is set to
0, it will disable S-curve function.
2)When the source of speed command is analog, the max. range of
P1-35 will be set within 20000 automatically.
Default: 0
Control
R
S, PR
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: ms
nge: 0 ~ 65500
Ran 6 (0: dissable this fu
unction)
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
ngs: Acce
Settin eleration / D eceleration Constant of
o S-Curve:
P1-34
4: Set the a
acceleration
n time of acc
celeration / deceleratio
on of
trapezoid
d-curve
P1-35
5: Set the d
deceleration
n time of acc
celeration / deceleratio
on of
trapezoid
d-curve
P1-36
6: Set the ssmoothing tiime of S-curve accelerration and
decelerattion
P1-344, P1-35 an nd P1-36 can
c be set individually . Even whe en P1-36 iss
set to
o 0, it still ha ation / deceleration of trrapezoid-cu
as accelera urve.
NO
OTE 1)W
When the so
ource of spe
eed command is analogg, and P1-3
36 is set to
0, it will disab
ble S-curve
e function.
2)W
When the so ource of speeed command is analogg, the max. range of
P1-36
P will be
e set within 10000 auto
omatically.
Analog Sp
peed Comm
mand Filterr
Analog spe
eed comma
and filter is provided
p esspecially forr ASDA-A2 series
s rs. It mainly helps with
users
buffer whe
en the analo
og input sign
nal changess too fast.
Sp
peed (rpm) Analo
og speed com
mmand Motorr Torque
30 00
0
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Time (sec)
(
00
-300
Analog spe
eed comma
and filter sm
mooth the an
nalog input command. Its time proogram is the
e same as
S-curve filtter in norma
al speed. Also, the spe
eed curve an
nd the acce
eleration currve are both
h
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-27
7
Chapter 6 Control Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
continuous. The above is the diagram of analog speed command filter. The slope of speed
command in acceleration and deceleration is different. Users could adjust the time setting (P1-34,
P1-35 and P1-36) according to the actual situation to improve the performance.
Default: 0
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Format: DEC
Settings: 0: Disabled
Target Speed
SFLT
5000rpm
The speed control ramp is
determined by parameter P1-40
3000rpm
-10 -5
-3000rpm
-5000rpm
Related parameters:
Address: 0150H
P1-40▲ VCM Maximum Speed of Analog Speed Command
0151H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.4
Unit: r/min
Range: 0 ~ 5000
Format: DEC
External analog
voltage or zero (0) S1
SON ON
NOTE 1) OFF means the contact point is open while ON means the contact point is
close.
2) When it is in Sz mode, the speed command S1 = 0; When it is in S mode,
the speed command S1 is the external analog voltage input.
3) When the servo drive is On, please select the command according to
SPD0~SPD1 status.
Many kinds of gain in speed control unit are adjustable. Two ways, manual and auto, are provided
for selection.
Manual: All parameters are set by users and the auto or auxiliary function will be disabled in this
mode.
Auto: General load inertia estimation is provided. It adjusts the parameter automatically. Its
framework is divided into PI auto gain adjustment and PDFF auto gain adjustment.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x2
Format: HEX
Manual Mode
When P2-32 is set to 0, users can define Speed Loop Gain (P2-04), Speed Integral Compensation
(P2-06) and Speed Feed Forward Gain (P2-07). Influence of each parameter is as the followings.
Proportional gain: To increase proportional gain can enhance the response frequency of speed
loop.
Integral gain: To increase the integral gain could increase the low-frequency stiffness of speed loop,
reduce the steady-state error and sacrifice the phase margin. The over high integral gain will cause
the instability of the system.
Feed forward gain: Diminish the deviation of phase delay.
Relevant parameters:
Address: 0208H
P2-04 KVP Speed Loop Gain
0209H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.6
Default: 500
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: rad/s
Range: 0 ~ 8191
Format: DEC
Settings: Increase the value of speed loop gain can enhance the speed
response. However, if the value is set too big, it would easily cause
resonance and noise.
Address: 020CH
P2-06 KVI Speed Integral Compensation
020DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.6
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: rad/s
Range: 0 ~ 1023
Format: DEC
Address: 020EH
P2-07 KVF Speed Feed Forward Gain
020FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.6
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Settings: When the speed control command runs smoothly, increasing the gain
value can reduce the speed command error. If the command does not
run smoothly, decreasing the gain value can reduce the mechanical
vibration during operation.
Theoretically, stepping response can be used to explain proportional gain (KVP), integral gain (KVI)
and feed forward gain (KVF). Here, the frequency domain and time domain are used to illustrate
the basic principle.
Frequency Domain
Time Domain
Generally, instrument is needed when applying frequency domain for measurement. Users are
required to adopt the measurement techniques; while time domain only needs a scope and goes
with the analog input / output terminal provided by the servo drive. Thus, time domain is frequently
used to adjust PI controller. The abilities of PI controller to deal with the resistance of torque load
and the following command are the same.
That is to say, the following command and resistance of torque load have the same performance in
frequency domain and time domain. Users can reduce the bandwidth by setting the low-pass filter
in command end.
Auto Mode
Auto mode adopts adaptive principle. The servo drive automatically adjusts the parameters
according to the external load. Since the adaptive principle takes longer time, it will be unsuitable if
the load changes too fast. It would be better to wait until the load inertia is steady or changes
slowly. Depending on the speed of signal input, the adaptive time will be different from one another.
Motor Speed
Inertia Estimation
Inertia Measurement
Default: 1000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Hz
Range: 50 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Settings: The first setting value of resonance frequency. If P2-24 is set to 0, this
function is disabled. P2-43 and P2-44 are the second Notch filter.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: dB
Format: DEC
Settings: The first resonance suppression (notch filter) attenuation rate. When
this parameter is set to 0, the function of Notch filter is disabled.
NOTE If the value of attenuation rate is set to 5, then, it would be -5dB.
Address: 0256H
P2-43 NCF2 Resonance Suppression (Notch filter) (2)
0257H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.7
Default: 1000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Hz
Range: 50 ~ 2000
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: dB
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: dB
Range: 0 ~ 32
Format: DEC
Address: 0232H
P2-25 NLP Low-pass Filter of Resonance Suppression
0233H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.7
Unit: 1 ms 0.1 ms
Settings: Set the low-pass filter of resonance suppression. When the value is set
to 0, the function of low-pass filter is disabled.
There are two sets of auto resonance suppression, one is P2-43 and P2-44 and another one is P2-
45 and P2-46. When the resonance occurs, set P2-47 to 1 or 2 (enable the function of resonance
suppression), the servo drive searches the point of resonance frequency and suppresses the
resonance automatically. Write the point of frequency into P2-43 and P2-45 and write the
attenuation rate into P2-44 and P2-46. When P2-47 is set to 1, the system will set P2-47 to 0
(disable the function of auto suppression) automatically after completing resonance suppression
and the system is stable for 20 minutes. When P2-47 is set to 2, the system will keep searching the
point of resonance.
When P2-47 is set to 1 or 2, but resonance still exists, please confirm the value of parameter P2-
44 and P2-46. If one of them is 32, it is suggested to reduce the speed bandwidth first and then
start to estimate again. If the value of both is smaller than 32 and resonance still exists, please set
P2-47 to 0 first and then manually increase the value of P2-44 and P2-46. It is suggested to reduce
the bandwidth if the resonance has not been improved. Then use the function of auto resonance
suppression.
When manually increase the value of P2-44 and P2-46, please check if the value of both is bigger
than 0. If yes, it means the frequency point of P2-43 and P2-45 is the one searched by auto
resonance suppression. If the value of both is 0, it means the default, 1000 of P2-43 and P2-45 is
not the one searched by auto resonance suppression. Deepen the resonance suppression
attenuation rate might worsen the situation.
Settings of P2-47
Current Value Desired Value Function
Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable
0 1
auto resonance suppression function.
Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable
0 2
auto resonance suppression function.
Save the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and disable
1 0
auto resonance suppression function.
Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable
1 1
auto resonance suppression function.
Do not clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and
1 2 enable auto resonance suppression function
continuously.
Save the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and disable
2 0
auto resonance suppression function.
Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable
2 1
auto resonance suppression function.
Do not clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and
2 2 enable auto resonance suppression function
continuously.
Check if vibration No
occurs
Yes
Set P2-47 = 1
No
Check if vibration
occurs
Yes
Yes
No
Set P2-47 = 0
No Check if vibration
condition has improved
Yes
Yes
Check if vibration
occurs
No
Set P2-47 = 0
Complete
Here illustrates the effect via low-pass filter (parameter P2-25). The following diagram is the
system open-loop gain with resonance.
Gain
Frequency
When the value of P2-25 is increased from 0, BW becomes smaller (See as the following diagram).
Although it solves the problem of resonance frequency, the response bandwidth and phase margin
is reduced.
Gain
0dB Frequency
BW
If users know the resonance frequency, notch filter (parameter P2-23 and P2-24) can directly
eliminate the resonance. The frequency setting range of notch filter is merely from 50 to 1000Hz.
The suppression strength is from 0 to 32dB. If the resonance frequency is not within the range, it is
suggested to use low-pass filter (parameter P2-25).
Here firstly illustrates the influence brought by notch filter (P2-23 and P2-24) and low-pass filter
(P2-25). The following diagrams are the system of open-loop gain with resonance.
Resonance
Resonance
Gain conditions
Point Gain Gain
Notch Filter is suppressed
0db
Low-pass Low-pass
Frequency Attenuation Frequency
Rate P2-24
When the value of P2-25 is increased from 0, BW becomes smaller. Although it solves the problem
of resonance frequency, the response bandwidth and phase margin is reduced. Also, the system
becomes unstable.
If users know the resonance frequency, notch filter (parameter P2-23 and P2-24) can directly
eliminate the resonance. In this case, notch filter will be more helpful than low-pass filter. However,
if the resonance frequency drifts because of time or other factors, notch filter will not do.
When neither TCM0 nor TCM1 is 0, parameters become the source of torque command.
The command will be executed after TCM0 ~ TCM1 are changed. There is no need to use
CTRG for triggering.
The torque command can be used in torque mode (T or Tz) and speed mode (S or Sz). When it is
in speed mode, it can be regarded as the command input of torque limit.
The torque command unit is to select torque command source according to Section 6.4.1, including
the scaling (P1-41) setting and S-curve setting. The current control unit manages the gain
parameters of the servo drive and calculates the current for servo motor in time. Since the current
control unit is very complicated, and is not relevant to the application. There is no need to adjust
parameters. Only command end setting is provided.
The structure of torque command unit is as the following diagram.
The upper path is the command from register while the lower one is external analog command.
The command is selected according to the status of TCM0, TCM1 and P1-01 (T or Tz). The torque
represented by analog voltage command can be adjusted via the scaling and can obtain a
smoother response via low-pass filter.
6.4.3 Sm
mooth Torq
que Comm
mand
Related pa
arameters:
Ad
ddress: 010
0EH
P1-07 TFLT Analog Torque
T Co
ommand (Lo
ow-pass Filter)
01
10FH
Operaational Reelated Section:
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 6.44.3
ault: 0
Defa
Control
T
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: ms
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
ngs: 0: Dis
Settin sabled
Target
T Speed
d
TFLT
6.4.4 The
e Scaling of Analog
g Comman
nd
The motorr torque co
ommand is controlled by the ana
alog voltage
e deviation between T_REF
T and
d
goes with parameter P1-41 to adju
GND and g ust the torque slope an
nd its rangee.
Related pa
arameters:
Ad
ddress: 015
52H
P1-41▲
▲ TCM Maximum Output o
of Analog Torque
T Command
01
153H
Operaational Reelated Section:
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 6.44.4
ault: 100
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: %
nge: 0 ~ 1000
Ran
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
6.4.5 Tim
ming Diagrram in Torrque Mode
e
NOTE
E 1. OFF means the co ontact pointt is open wh
hile ON meaans the con tact point is
s close.
2. When it is in Tz mo
ode, the torrque comma and T1 = 0; When it is in T mode, the
torque command T1 T is the exxternal analog voltage input.
3. When it is Servo On,
O please sselect the command ac ccording to TCM0~TCM M1 status.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-47
7
Chapter 6 Control Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
Sz and Tz dual mode is not provided here. For avoiding occupying too many digital inputs in dual
mode, speed and torque mode can use external analog voltage as the command source so as to
reduce digital input (SPD0, SPD1 or TCM0, TCM1). Please refer to Chapter 3.3.2, table 3.1,
Default Value of DI Input Function and table 3.2, Default Value of DO Output Function for the
default DI/DO of each mode.
The relationship between DI/DO signals and PIN define are set after the mode is selected. If users
desire to change the setting, please refer to Chapter 3.3.4.
S-P
In speed mode (S-P is ON), the speed command is selected via SPD0 and SPD1. CTRG is not
working at the moment. When switching to position mode (S-P is OFF), since position command
has not been issued (needs to wait the rising edge of CTRG), the motor stops. The position
command is determined by POS0~POS5 and triggered by rising edge of CTRG. When S-P is ON,
it goes back to speed mode again. Please refer to the introduction of single mode for DI signal and
the selected command of each mode.
S-T
In torque mode (S-T is ON), the torque command is selected via TCM0 and TCM1. When
switching to speed mode (S-T is OFF), the torque command is selected via SPD0 and SPD 1. The
motor operates according to the speed command. When S-T is ON, it goes back to the torque
mode again. Please refer to the introduction of single mode for DI signal and the selected
command of each mode.
In torque mode (T-P is ON), the torque command is selected via TCM0 and TCM1. CTRG is not
working at the moment. When switching to position mode (T-P is OFF), since position command
has not been issued (needs to wait the rising edge of CTRG), the motor stops. The position
command is determined by POS0~POS5 and triggered by rising edge of CTRG. When T-P is ON,
it goes back to torque mode again. Please refer to the introduction of single mode for DI signal and
the selected command of each mode.
6.6 Oth
hers
6.6.1 The
e Use of Speed
S Limit
The maxim
mum speed
d in each mode
m is limiited by inte
ernal param
meters (P1-555), not ma
atter it is in
n
position, sp
peed or torq
que mode.
The issuin
ng method of speed limit comma
and and speed comma
and is the same. The
e command
d
source cou
uld be exte
ernal analog
g voltage o
or internal parameter
p (P1-09
( ~ P
P1-11). Plea
ase refer to
o
Section 6.3
3.1 for desccriptions.
Speed limiit can be ussed in torqu
ue mode (T)) only. It is used for lim
miting the m
motor speed. When the
e
command in torque mode
m is iss
sued by extternal analo
og voltage, DI signal i s enough and
a can be
e
regarded as SPD0~ d to deterrmine the speed lim it comman
~SPD1 which is used nd (internall
parameterss). If the DI signal is no
ot enough, speed limit command can be issuued by anallog voltage..
When the function off disable/enable limit fu
unction in P1-02
P is set to 1, the sspeed limit function iss
enabled. S
See the timin
ng diagram as below.
6.6.2 The
e Use of Torque
T Lim
mit
The issuin
ng method of
o torque limit comma
and and torrque command is the same. The
e command
d
source cou
uld be exte
ernal analog
g voltage o
or internal parameter
p (P1-12
( ~ P
P1-14). Plea
ase refer to
o
Chapter 6.4.1 for desccriptions.
mit can be used
Torque lim u in position mode (PT, PR) or
o speed mo
ode (S). It iis used for limiting the
e
motor torque output. When
W the command
c in
n position mode
m is issued by exterrnal analog voltage, DII
signal is e M1, which is used to determine torque limitt
enough and can be regarded as TCM0~TCM
command (internal pa
arameters). If the DI sig
gnal is not enough,
e torq
que limit coommand can
n be issued
d
by analog voltage. Wh
hen the function of disa
able/enable
e torque limit function inn P1-02 is set
s to 1, the
e
torque limit function iss enabled. See
S the timiing diagram
m as below.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 6-51
Chapter 6 Control Mode of Operation ASDA-A2
Default: 00
Unit: -
Range: 00 ~ 0x77
Format: HEX
Settings:
MON1,
MON2
Description
Setting
Value
0 Motor speed (+/-8 Volts/Max. speed)
1 Motor torque (force) (+/-8 Volts/Max. torque (force))
MON1 output voltage 8 (unit:Volts)
.
MON2 output voltage 8
.
(unit: Volts)
Address: 0106H
P1-03 AOUT Polarity Setting of Encoder Pulse Output
0107H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 3.3.3
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x13
Format: HEX
Settings:
Not in use
Address: 0108H
P1-04 MON1 MON1 Analog Monitor Output Proportion
0109H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.4.4
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to parameter P0-03 for the setting of analog output
selection.
For example:
P0-03 = 0x00 (MON1 is the speed analog output)
When the output voltage value of MON1 is V1:
Motor speed = (Max. speed ×V1/8) ×P1-04/100
Address: 0108H
P1-05 MON2 MON2 Analog Monitor Output Proportion
0109H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.4.4
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to parameter P0-03 for the setting of analog output
selection.
For example:
P0-03 = 0x00 (MON2 is the speed analog output)
When the output voltage value of MON2 is V2:
Motor speed = (Max. ×V2/8) ×P1-05/100
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: mV
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: mV
Format: DEC
For example, if users desire to observe the voltage signal in channel 1 and set this channel for
observing the pulse command frequency, when the pulse command frequency 2.25M corresponds
to 8V output voltage, users need to adjust the monitor output proportion of P1-04 to 50 (= 2.25M/
Max. input frequency). Other related settings include P0-03 (X= 3) and P1-03 (The polarity setting
range of monitor analog output is between 0 and 3, and it can set positive/negative polarity output).
Generally speaking, the output voltage of Ch1 is V1; the pulse command frequency is (Max. input
frequency ×V1/8) ×P1-04/100.
Because of the offset value, the zero voltage level of analog monitor output does not match to the
zero point of the setting. This can be improved via the setting of offset adjustment value of analog
monitor output, DOF1 (4-20) and DOF2 (P4-21). The voltage level of analog monitor output is ±8V,
if the output voltage exceeds the range, it will be limited within ±8V. The provided resolution is
about 10bits, which equals to 13mV/LSB.
8V
DOF
-8V
If it works during the process of acceleration or constant speed, the servo drive needs to generate
more current to resist the brakeforce of brake and it might cause the alarm of overload warning.
MBT1(P1-42) MBT2(P1-43)
ZSPD(P1-38)
Motor Speed
1. When Servo OFF, go through the time set by P1-43 and the motor speed is faster than the
setting in P1-38, DO.BRKR is OFF (the brake is locked).
2. When Servo Off, has not reached the time set by P1-43 but the motor speed is slower than
the setting in P1-38, DO.BRKR is OFF (the brake is locked.).
2)The brake signal controls the solenoid valve, provides power to the
brake and enables the brake.
4)Do not use brake power and control power (VDD) at the same time.
L1, L2
Control Circuit
Power
1 sec
5V
Control Circuit
Power
> 0msec
R, S, T
Main Circuit
Power
800ms
BUS Voltage
READY
2 sec
SERVO
READY
SERVO ON
(DI Input)
1 msec (min)+ Response Filter Time of Digital Input ( P2-09)
SERVO ON
(DO Output)
Input available
Position \ Speed \
Torque Command
Input
Item Descriptions
Variable Each monitoring variable has a code. Set the code via P0-02 so that the users
Code can monitor the variable.
Format Every monitoring variable is saved with the format of 32-bit (long integer) in the
servo drive.
Classification It is divided into basic variables and extension variables:
1. Basic variables: Use the Monitor Mode on the panel to find the variable
(variables in the cycle) by pressing UP/ DOWN Key (P0-02 = 0~26)
2. Extension variables: Variables other than the basic ones (P0-02 = 27~127)
Monitor Two methods, Panel display and Mapping:
Method 1. Panel display: View through the panel directly
2. Mapping: Correspond the variables to the system parameters and view
the variables via parameters.
Panel 1. Switch to the Monitor Mode by pressing the MODE Key and select the
Display desired monitoring variables via UP/DOWN Key.
2. Directly enter the desired monitoring code via P0-02 for viewing.
Pressing the SHF Key on the panel can switch the display of high / low
word; Pressing the SET Key on the panel can switch the display of
decimal / hexadecimal format.
Mapping 1. Mapping parameters that support monitoring variable are P0-09 ~ P0-13.
Please refer to Chapter 8.3 for parameter description.
2. Monitoring variables can be read via communication by mapping
parameters.
3. The value of mapping parameters (P0-09~P0-13) is the content of basic
variables (17h, 18h, 19h, 1Ah). The setting value which is set by P0-17
should be monitored via p0-09 (refer to p0-02). When accessing data via
communication, the value of P0-17 can be read or monitored via panel
(Set P0-02 to 23). When the panel shows「VAR-1」, it means it is the
value of P0-09.
The descriptions of monitoring variables attribute are as the following.
Attribute Descriptions
B BASE: basic variables. Variables that can be viewed by UP/DOWN Key on the
panel.
Dn When the panel displays, the position of the decimal point will be D1 which
means it only shows one decimal point; D2 means it shows two decimal points.
Dec When the panel displays, the information only can be shown in decimal format.
Pressing the SET Key on the panel cannot switch it to hexadecimal format.
Hex When the panel displays, the information only can be shown in hexadecimal
format. Pressing the SET Key on the panel cannot switch it to decimal format.
Name of Variables /
Code Descriptions
Attribute
000 Feedback position The current feedback position of the motor encoder. The
(00h) (PUU) B unit is PUU (user unit).
The current coordinate of position command. The unit is
PUU (user unit).
PT mode: it represents the pulse number the servo drive
001 Position command received.
(01h) (PUU) B PR mode: the value of absolute coordinate from position
command
Equals to the pulse number sent by the controller.
002 Position deviation The deviation between the position command and feedback
(02h) (PUU) B position. The unit is PUU (user unit).
003 Feedback position Current feedback position of the motor encoder. The unit is
(03h) (pulse) B pulse (encoder unit).
The current coordinate of the position command. The unit is
004 Position command pulse (encoder unit).
(04h) (pulse) B
The command that had gone through E-gear.
005 Position deviation The deviation between the position command and feedback
(05h) (pulse) B position. The unit is pulse (encoder unit).
Frequency of pulse command received by the servo drive.
006 Pulse command The unit is Kpps.
(06h) frequency B
It is suitable in PT/PR mode.
Current speed of the motor. The unit of rotary motor is 0.1
007 Speed feedback r/min.
(07h) B D1 Dec The value is more stable since it has been though low-pass
filter.
Speed command
008 The speed command is issued by analog. The unit is 0.01
(analog)
(08h) Volt.
B D2 Dec
009 Speed command The processed speed command. The source might be
(09h) (processed) B analog, register or position loop.
Torque command
010 (analog) The torque command is issued by analog. The unit is 0.01
(0Ah) Volt.
B D2 Dec
The processed torque command. The unit is percentage
011 Torque command (%).
(0Bh) (processed) B
The source might be analog, register or speed loop.
012 Average load output by the servo drive. The unit is
Average load B
(0Ch) percentage (%).
013 The maximum load output by the servo drive. The unit is
Peak load B
(0Dh) percentage (%).
014
DC Bus voltage B Capacitor voltage after rectification. The unit is Volt.
(0Eh)
Monitoring Variables /
Code Explanation
Attribute
015 Inertia ratio
Ratio of load inertia and motor inertia. The unit is 0.1 times.
(0Fh) B D1 Dec
016
IGBT temperature B IGBT temperature. Unit is °C.
(10h)
Resonance frequency of the system, including 2 groups of
frequency, F1 and F2.
When monitoring via panel, pressing SHF can switch the
display of both:
017 Resonance frequency F2 shows no decimal point while F1 shows one.
(11h) B Dec When reading through communication (mapping
parameter):
Low-16 Bit (Low WORD) returns frequency F2.
High-16 Bit (High WORD) returns frequency F1.
The offset between the motor position and Z phase. The
018 Z phase offset range is from -5000 to +5000.
(12h) B Dec If the position is the same as Z phase, its value is 0. The
bigger the value is, the more the offset will be.
019 Mapping parameter Return the value of parameter P0-25 which is mapped by
(13h) #1 B P0-35.
020 Mapping parameter Return the value of parameter P0-26 which is mapped by
(14h) #2 B P0-36.
021 Mapping parameter Return the value of parameter P0-27 which is mapped by
(15h) #3 B P0-37.
022 Mapping parameter # Return the value of parameter P0-28 which is mapped by
(16h) 4B P0-38.
023 Mapping monitoring Return the value of parameter P0-09 which is the
(17h) variable #1 B monitoring variables mapped by P0-17.
024 Mapping monitoring Return the value of parameter P0-20 which is the
(18h) variable #2 B monitoring variables mapped by P0-18.
025 Mapping monitoring Return the value of parameter P0-11 which is the
(19h) variable #3 B monitoring variables mapped by P0-19
026 Mapping monitoring Return the value of parameter P0-12 which is the
(1Ah) variable # 4 B monitoring variables mapped by P0-20.
028 Alarm codes Alarm codes of DMCNET mode (It is applicable to A2-F,
(1Ch) A2-N, A2-M/U/L)
029 Feedback of auxiliary The position feedback from auxiliary encoder (CN5)
(1Dh) encoder (PUU) (It is applicable to A2-F)
030 Position error of Position deviation between position feedback (from CN5)
auxiliary encoder and command (It is applicable to A2-F)
(1Eh) (PUU)
031 Position error or Feedback position deviation between main encoder and
main/auxiliary encoder auxiliary encoder (It is applicable to A2-F)
(1Fh) (PUU)
Name of Variables /
Code Description
Attribute
035 Indexing coordinate The current command of the indexing coordinates. The unit
(23h) command is PUU (user unit).
Display the compare data. This actual compare data is a
037 Compare data of compare value plus an offset value via P1-23 and P1-24.
(25h) COMPARE
CMP_DATA = DATA_ARRAY[*] + P1-23 + P1-24
038
Voltage level of battery The voltage level of battery for an absolute encoder.
(26h)
The processed DI status of the servo drive. Each bit
039 DI status (Integrated) corresponds to one DI channel.
(27h) Hex The source includes hardware channel / software P4-07
which is determined by P3-06.
040 DO status (Hardware) The real status of Digital Output hardware. Each bit
(28h) Hex corresponds to one DI channel.
041 Return the value of P0-46. Please refer to the description of
Drive Status
(29h) the parameter.
043 The Data captured by CAP hardware from the latest time
CAP, data capturing
(2Bh) Note: CAP could continuously capture many points.
048
Auxiliary encoder CNT The value of pulse counter from auxiliary encoder (CN5)
(30h)
049
Pulse command CNT The value of pulse counter from pulse command (CN1)
(31h)
Speed command The processed speed command. The unit is 0.1 r/min.
050 (processed)
(32h) The source might be analog, register or position loop.
D1 Dec
Speed feedback
051 (immediate) Current actual speed of the motor. The unit is 0.1 r/min.
(33h)
D1 Dec
052 Speed feedback (filter)
Current actual speed of the motor. The unit is 0.1 r/min.
(34h) D1 Dec
Torque command The processed torque command. The unit is 0.1 percent
053 (processed) (%).
(35h)
D1 Dec The source might be analog, register or speed loop.
054 Torque feedback Current actual torque (force) of the motor. The unit is 0.1
(36h) D1 Dec percent (%).
Electric current
055 feedback Current actual electric current of the motor. The unit is 0.01
(37h) ampere (Amp).
D2 Dec
056 DC Bus voltage
Capacitor voltage after rectification. The unit is 0.1 volt.
(38h) D1 Dec
Pulse from E-Cam
059 master axis The accumulative pulse number of E-Cam master axis. It is
(3Bh) the same as P5-86. A2L does not support this function.
(accumulation)
Monitoring Variables /
Code Explanation
Attribute
Pulse from E-Cam
060 The incremental pulse number from master axis. The unit is
master axis
(3Ch) pulse number per msec. A2L does not support this function.
(increment)
Pulse from E-Cam The lead pulse of E-Cam master axis which is used to
mast axis judge the engaging condition.
061 (lead pulse) When it is disengaged: lead pulse = P5-87 or P5-92.
(3Dh) When it is engaged: lead pulse = P5-89. When the value is
0, it will be disengaged.
A2L does not support this function.
The position of E-Cam The position of E-Cam axis.
axis Unit: The pulse is from the master axis. When the
062 incremental pulse from master axis is P, the axis rotates M
(3Eh)
cycle (P5-83=M, P5-84=P).
A2L does not support this function.
063 Position of E-Cam The position of E-Cam slave axis. Unit: PUU
(3Fh) slave axis A2L does not support this function.
064 Terminal register of PR In PR mode, the termination of position command (Cmd_E)
(40h) command
065 Output register of PR In PR mode, the accumulative output of position command
(41h) command
067 PR target speed The target speed of path command in PR mode. The unit is
(43h) PPS (Pulse Per Second)
S-curve filter (input) The input commands of S-curve filter which is used to
068 smooth the input command.
(44h) It is effective in PR mode, E-Cam and speed command.
A2L does not support this function.
S-curve filter (output) The output commands of S-curve filter which is used to
069 smooth the output command.
(45h) It is effective in PR mode, E-Cam and speed command.
A2L does not support this function.
Speed command of PR In PR mode, the programmed trapezoid speed curve is
076 contour determined by the target speed, acceleration, deceleration
(4Ch) and moving distance (before S-curve filter).
The unit is PPS (Pulse Per Second).
Synchronous capture When synchronous capture axis is enabled, the received
081
axis pulse number between two captures can be used to
(51h)
Incremental input pulse measure the real distance of Mark.
082 PR number that is To inform HMC the PR number that is being executed (It is
(52h) currently executed applicable to A2-F)
Synchronous capture The deviation between the real output pulse and the target
084 axis pulse when synchronous capture axis is enabled. If it
(54h) Deviation pulse reaches the synchronization, the value will close to 0.
number
091 The feedback of The immediate feedback position of indexing coordinates.
(5Bh) indexing coordinate The unit is PUU (user unit).
Name of Variables /
Code Description
Attribute
Firmware version It includes two versions, DSP and CPLD.
Dec When monitoring via panel, pressing the SHF Key can
switch the display of both:
096 DSP shows no decimal point while CPLD shows one.
(60h) When reading through communication (parameter
mapping):
Low-16 Bit (Low WORD) returns DSP version number.
High-16 Bit (High WORD) returns CPLD version number.
098 PLC scan time The update time of DI/DO. The unit is 0.5 msec.
(62h)
109 The amount of data Returns the amount of data array. The unit is DWORD (32
(6Dh) array Bits)
111 Error code of the servo Error code of the servo drive: only for the control loop, not
(6Fh) drive including the motion controller.
CANopen SYNC TS The time the servo drive receives SYNC signal
112
(hasn’t been through (TimeStamp)
(70h)
the filter) The unit is usec.
CANopen SYNC TS The time the servo drive receives SYNC signal and has
113
(has been through the been through the filter. The unit is usec.
(71h)
filter)
114 CANopen To synchronize the device timing with the controller during
(72h) timing synchronization the operation. The unit is usec.
The differential The differential between the current position and Z phase
116 between position and position of auxiliary encoder
(74h) Z phase of auxiliary (It is applicable to A2-F)
encoder (pulse)
120 DMCNET connection DMCNET connection status (It is applicable to A2-F, A2-N)
(78h) status
The PDO packet of Accumulative number of the lost DMCNET PDO packet (It
DMCNET is lost is applicable to A2-F, A2-N)
121 during transmission Format: chAchB | chB | chA
(79h)
For example, 459010 = 0x070102 chAchBerror = 7,
chBerror = 1, chAerror = 2
The returned value The returned value when monitoring via panel
123
when monitoring via
(7Bh)
panel
Many functions of motion control, such as CAPTURE, COMPARE and E-Cam (A2L does not
support E-Cam function) are the data that needs to be saved in large amount of memory space,
therefore, the servo drive reserves a continuous internal space to satisfy the need. The main
feature of the data array is as the followings:
Feature Introduction of Data Array
Usage Save the captured data of CAPTURE
Save the compared value of COMPARE
Save the contour table of E-Cam
Note:
1. The system does not partition off the data array into the individual
space of CAP, CMP and E-Cam. The user could program it
according to the demand. Therefore, the space might be
overlapped. Please pay close attention to it when using.
2. A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Size of Data Array 32-bit integer x 800 (refer to P5-10)
Each data has its corresponding address. Specify the address is
a must when reading or writing the data.
The 800 data is from 0 to 799.
Data Retained Manually set up the saving (P2-08 = 30, 35) is a must and the
data should be saved in EEPROM of the servo drive.
Save the data when it is Servo Off.
The data will be loaded into data array automatically when it is
Servo On.
Accessing Window Should be access via parameter P5-10 ~ P5-13.
The content of the data array cannot be read or wrote directly, reading or writing the data must
via parameter P5-10 ~ P5-13. The description of the parameters is as the followings:
P5-13 Reading / Read via panel: After reading the content of P5-11, the value of
writing P5-11 will increase 1 automatically.
window #2 Write via panel: It cannot be written via panel.
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Read via communication: After reading the content of P5-11,
the value of P5-11 will increase 1
automatically.
Write via communication: After writing the content of P5-11, the
value of P5-11 will increase 1
automatically.
Set the desired reading / writing address via P5-11 first. Then, read / write P5-12 or P5-13 in
order to access the content of data array. If users desire to continuously write 3 data, 100, 200,
300 into the address of data array, 11, 12 and 13, the operation step is as follows:
A. Write via panel: Use P5-12 (reading / writing window #1), since P5-13 does not support writing
via panel:
1. Set address: Set P5-11 to 11 (The first written address)
2. Write into data: Set P5-12 to 100 (After writing 100 into address 11 in data array, the value of
P5-11 will increase 1 automatically.)
Set P5-12 to 200 (After writing 200 into address 12 in data array, the value of
P5-11 will increase 1 automatically.)
Set P5-12 to 300 (After writing 300 into address 13 in data array, the value of
P5-11 will increase 1 automatically.)
The last step is to read address 11, 12 and 13 and check if the content is the value that just wrote
into.
B. Read via panel: Use P5-13 (reading / writing window #2) so as to continuously read the
content.
1. Set address: Set P5-11 to 11 (The first read address)
6 13 0 300 0 400 0
2 0x10 P5-11
(Word) The third address The third data The fourth data
6 15 0 500 0 600 0
3 0x10 P5-11
(Word) The fifth address The fifth data The sixth data
If users desire to read the value of data array in order to check the previous written content, users
can write the desired reading start address into P5-11 via MODBUS communication command
0x06 (write 1 data). The issuing communication command is as the following:
Content of Communication Command: Set the Reading Address of Data Array
No. Command Start Add. Written Data
4 0x06 P5-11 11
Then, read the content of specified address by communication command 0x03 (continuous
reading). The issuing communication command is as follows:
Content of Communication Command: Return Data
Read Data Array
P5-11 P5-12 P5-13
Start Read
No. Command Low High Low High Low High
Add. Amount
Word Word Word Word Word Word
11 0 100 0 200 0
6
5 0x03 P5-11 Data of Data of
(Word) Read address
address 11 address 12
13 0 300 0 400 0
6
6 0x03 P5-11 Data of Data of
(Word) Read address
address 13 address 14
15 0 500 0 600 0
6
7 0x03 P5-11 Data of Data of
(Word) Read address
address 15 address 16
The return value on the right-hand side of the above table represents the read parameter, P5-11,
P5-12 and P5-13, which is also the content of address 11~16 in data array.
7.5 The Difference between General PR Mode and the One in ASDA-A2
General PR Mode PR Mode in A2R
Command 8 64
Number
Command Type Positioning Command Positioning/Constant speed Command
PR jump, write in parameters
Position Absolute or incremental Absolute / incremental can be set
Command Acceleration/Deceleration individually
Parameter time x 1 set Acceleration/Deceleration time x 16
Motion speed x 8 sets sets
Delay time x 8 sets Motion speed x 16 sets
Delay time x 16 sets
Command It has to wait until DO.ZSPD is Anytime will do. It could specify the next
Triggering Time ON command issuing method (in sequence /
interrupt / overlap)
Command Use DI.CTRG + POSn Use DI.CTRG + POSn
Triggering Event trigger: DI.Event+CAP
Method
complete
P5-07, fill in PR number to trigger.
Position Trapezoid curve with S- Trapezoid curve with S-curve filter
Command curve filter (Trapezoid curve and S-curve can
PROFILE (If S-curve is not enabled, then it be set individually.
has no function of acceleration /
deceleration)
Format of Two register for turns and PUU (32bit)
Position pulse within one turn
Command respectively.
Homing The function is enabled The function is enabled
Function automatically when the automatically when the power is On.
power is On. (Servo ON for (Servo ON for the first time)
the first time) Use DI.SHOM to trigger
Use DI.SHOM to trigger PR 0 = Homing
After homing is completed, the
specified PR will be executed
automatically.
Software limit No Yes
protection
Absolute Cmd_E = command data Cmd_E does not Cmd_E does not change.
Positioning (absolute) change.
Cmd_O = Cmd_E
Command
Cmd_O does not change. Cmd_O continuously
DO.CMD_OK is ON
output
DO.CMD_OK is OFF
...
Incremental Cmd_E+= command data Cmd_E does not Cmd_E does not change.
Positioning (incremental) change.
Cmd_O = Cmd_E
Command
Cmd_O does not change. Cmd_O continuously
DO.CMD_OK is ON
output
DO.CMD_OK is OFF
...
Issue the Cmd_E does not change. Cmd_E does not Cmd_E does not change.
command of change.
Cmd_O continuously output Cmd_O = position after
DI:STP to Cmd_O stops stop
DO.CMD_OK is
according to the
stop the unchangeable DO.CMD_OK is ON
deceleration curve
command
Homing Cmd_E does not change. Cmd_E continuously Cmd_E = the absolute
Command output position of Z
Cmd_O does not change.
Cmd_O continuously Cmd_O = position after
DO.CMD_OK is OFF
output stop
DO.HOME is OFF
... DO.CMD_OK is ON
... DO.HOME is ON
Enter PR (Servo Off->On or switch the mode Cmd_O = Cmd_E = current feedback position
and enter into PR mode)
DO signal:
System frame:
DI.CTRG
DO.CMD_OK
DLY
Command is issuing
Servo positioning
DO.TPOS is complete
PR procedure is
DO.CMD_OK complete
64 command procedures are in each axis of PR mode. Procedure #0 is homing and the others
(#1~#63) are the procedures that users can self-define. The command triggered method is
concluded as the followings:
Command Source Description
Standard DI.CTRG + POS0 ~ 5 Use DI.POS0 ~ 5 to trigger the desired procedure number.
trigger Then, use the rising edge of DI.CTRG to trigger PR
command.
Application: PC or PLC that issues command via DI
Functional DI.STP, SHM When DI.STP is from OFF ON, the command stops in
trigger half way.
When DI.SHM is from OFF ON, it starts homing.
Event DI.EV1~4 The change status of DI.EV1 ~ 4 can be the triggered event.
trigger Set the triggered procedure number from OFF ON by
parameter P5-98.
Set the triggered procedure number from ON OFF by
parameter P5-99.
Application: connect to the sensor and trigger the preset
procedure.
Software P5-07 Directly write the procedure number into P5-07 and trigger
trigger command.
Both panel and communication (RS-232/485/CANopen)
can do.
Application: PC or PLC that issues command via
communication.
Other CAP trigger After the capture is completed, procedure #50 can be
E-CAM disengage triggered and activated by the setting value Bit3 of P5-39 X.
trigger When E-cam is disengaged and returns to PR mode, the
procedure specified by P5-88 BA setting value can be
triggered.
A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Bit 15 ~ 0 BIT
W0 TARGET_SPEED: 0.1 ~ 6000.0(r/min)
Bit 15 ~ 0
W0 T_ACC / T_DEC: 1 ~ 65500 (msec)
Bit 15 ~ 0
W0 IDLE:0 ~ 32767(msec)
32 bit
P5-00 Reserved
P5-01 Reserved (It is for testing only, do not use)
P5-02 Reserved (It is for testing only, do not use)
P5-03 Deceleration time of auto protection
P5-04 Homing mode
P5-05 1st Speed setting of high speed homing
P5-06 2nd Speed setting of low speed homing
P5-07 PR command register
P5-08 Forward software limit
P5-09 Reverse software limit
P6-00 Homing setting
P6-01 Origin definition
Note: Path (procedure)
Each PR has two parameters; the PR function is determined by TYPE. DATA represents position
or speed data while the others are the additional information.
When this command is executing, the motor accelerates or decelerates from the current speed
until it reaches the target speed. After the command is completed, the motor will remain at the
same speed and never stop.
OPT:
OPT
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
- UNIT AUTO INS
DLY: 0 ~ F, delay time number (4 BIT). The delay after executing this PR. The external INS is
invalid.
DLY (4) Index P5-40 ~ P5-55
7) POSITION, Positioning control: (TYPE = 2, PR is completed and stopped), (TYPE = 3, the next
PR is executed automatically after the PR is completed)
OPT:
OPT
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
Explanation
CMD OVLP INS
0 0 Absolute position command: Cmd_E = DATA (Note 1)
1 0 Incremental position command: Cmd_E = Cmd_E + DATA
(Note 2)
0 1 - - Relative position command: Cmd_E = Current feedback
position + DATA (Note 3)
1 1 Capture position command: Cmd_E = Capture position +
DATA (Note 4)
OPT:
OPT
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
- - - INS
PATH_NO: The jump target procedure number
FUNC_CODE: Reserved
DLY: The delay time after jump
OPT:
OPT
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
- - AUTO INS
Note: 1. Even when the written parameter is retained, the new value will not be written into
EEPROM. Too frequent written will not shorten the lifetime of EEPROM.
Note: The aim of writing parameters via PR procedure is for turning ON/OFF or
adjusting some functions. (E.g. according to different positioning command to
adjust P2-00, Position Loop Gain.) This procedure will continuously repeat during
the operation. If the data is all written into EEPROM, it will shorten the lifetime of
EEPROM. In addition, if P2-30 is set to 5, the modified parameters (either from
panel or communication) will not be saved and is inconvenient to use. Thus, this
new function is added.
3. If writing parameters fails, alarm AL.213~219 will occur (Refer to Chapter 11 of the manual)
and the next PR which is enabled by AUTO function will not be executed.
OPT:
OPT
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
DIR
00: Always move forward (Forward Rotation)
01: Always move reverse (Reverse Rotation)
10: Shortest distance (Judging by the current position and target
position)
11: Reserved
OVLP INS
OPT2:
OPT2
Bit 27 Bit 26 Bit 25 Bit 24
- AUTO - S_LOW
AUTO: Position reached and the next PR is loaded automatically.
S_LOW: Selection of speed unit. 0 means the unit is 0.1r/min; while 1 means 0.01r/min
11) Homing Definition: P6-00 ~ P6-01, (64 bits) one set of PR.
1) After finding the origin (Sensor or Z), the motor has to decelerate to stop. The stop position will
slightly exceed the origin. After the positioning is completed, users can determine and setup the
motor position:
2) Homing does not define the offset value but uses PATH to specify a path as the offset value.
After finding the origin, if the user desires to move a short distance of offset S (the related
home Sensor or Z) and set the coordinate to P after moving: (incremental positioning command
= S will do)
7.10.1 The Relation between the Previous Path and the Next Path
1) Interrupt (the previous path) and overlap (the next path) can be set in every path
7.11 The
e Descrip
ption of E-Cam
E F
Function
E-Cam is a virtual cam which is implemente
ed by softw
ware. It inclu
udes Masteer axis and Slave axis..
The illustra
ation is as th
he following
g:
In PT mod
de, the posittion comma
and (slave) is issued by
b the external pulse innput (maste
er). The two
o
is merely tthe linear scaling relattion (its sca
aling equals
s to e-gear ratio). How
wever, instea
ad of linearr
scaling, E--Cam is deffined by cyc
clic curve prrofile, just lik
ke the cam shape. In pphysical ma
achine cam,,
slave axis can opera
ate as varia
able speed motion, altternating motion, interm
mittent mottion, etc byy
master axis with the constant
c speed motion
n. It is very extensive
e in
n applicatioon. Using E--Cam could
d
have similar effect. The
T followin
ng table de
escribes the
e difference
es between E-Cam an
nd Machine
e
Cam.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 7-27
7
ASDA-A2 Chapter 7 Motion Control
Features of E-Cam
Operation Operate the E-cam in PR mode only.
Active the E-Cam Function 0: disable E-cam function and force to disengage (default).
P5-88.X 1: enable E-cam function and starts to judge the engaged condition.
E-Cam Status Stop / Pre-engage / Engage
Source of Master Axis Auxiliary encoder (linear scale)
Pulse command
CAP axis (defined by CAP function)
PR command
Time axis
Synchronous capture axis
Motion Command of the The overlap motion command issued by PR and E-Cam
Servo Drive Command of the Servo Drive = E-Cam command + PR
command
The command will be issued only in Engaged status
PR command is effective regardless to the E-Cam status.
Except when E-cam is engaging and the source of master axis
is PR command, PR command is 0.
When E-Cam is operating, its position still can be adjusted by PR
command (incremental command in general).
Data Storage Address of It is stored in Data array and the start address is set by P5-81.
E-Cam table
Data Size of E-Cam table It is set by P5-82. 720 points is the maximum and 5 points is
the minimum.
Data Format of E-Cam 32-bit signed value.
table
Data Content of E-Cam Save the position of slave axis (User unit, PUU)
table
The operation of E-Cam The master axis operates by incremental command input.
position The slave axis issues position command incrementally.
The start and the end of E-Cam curve profile could not always
be the same. It depends on the value of E-Cam table.
The command is interpolated by cubic curve. The torque on
each point will be smoothly connected because of quadratic
differential operation.
E-Cam provided by this servo drive and below is its functional diagram:
Function The moving distance of the master axis is the source which could
drive the E-Cam
Source of Master Source selected by P5-88.Y:
Axis Auxiliary encoder (linear scale)
The Setting Value Pulse command
of P5-88 Y PR command
Time axis
Synchronous capture axis
CAP axis (defined by CAP function)
Position of Master The position of master axis can be monitored via P5-86. It also can
Axis be written before the E-cam engaged. To change this parameter
P5-86 will not influence the position of the slave. It is because the moving
distance of master axis remains.
Status Description:
D :
Stop p: It is the in s of the cam
nitial status m. The E-cam m will not operate
with the master puls se. When E-cam
E functiion is disab
bled (P5-
88.X=0),, it returns tot this status.
Pre--engage: W When the en ngaged condition (pathh 1) is
established d, it enters this status. TThe E-cam still will
not operate e with the master
m pulsee.
Eng gage: When n it reaches pre-engage ed status (ppath 3), it enters
this sstatus. The E-cam starrts to operatte with the master
m
pulse e.
escription:
Path De
Path
h 1:When the engage
ed condition
n is establisshed (P5-88
8.Z), the
statuss is Stop → Pre-engage
ed.
The le
ead pulse is determined
d by P5-87.
Path
h 2:When the E-cam function is disabled (P
P5-88.X=0), it
ns to Stop status.
return s
Path
h 3:When it is in pre--engaged sttatus, the sttatus is Pre-
ged → Enga
engag aged.
Path
h 4:When the disengaged condition is estabblished (P5
5-
88.U= ged → Pre--engaged. The
=4), the stattus is Engag T lead
pulse is determinned by P5-992. (It is avaailable after
firmwa
are version V1.006sub b04)
Patth 5:Whenn the disenggaged condition is estaablished (P5
5-
88.U=
=1,2,6), or the
t E-cam function is ddisabled (P5 5-
88.X= ged → Stopp.
=0), the stattus is Engag
Engage When th he E-cam iss in Stop sta atus, the me ethod of dettermine enggaged
C
Condition (path 1)) is as the foollowing:
P5-88.Z 0: Engaaged immed diately. If P5
5-88.X is se et to 1, the eengaged condition
is esttablished.
1: When n DI.CAM iss ON, E-cam m is engage ed.
2: Fromm CAP to en ngaged: E-c cam is engaged when C CAP functio
on is
enabled. After en ngaged, it starts
s to cou
unt the movving distance e. Since
the CAP
C n is captured by hardware, it has ggood instan
position ntaneity
n software delay, whic
and no ch is suitablle for the opperating ma
aster
axis before
b engaaged.
Lead Pulse In pre-engaged status, the lead pulse is the moving distance of
master axis before the E-cam is engaged (path 3). Its value
Monitoring
decreases when input the master pulse. When the value is 0, it
Variables
enters Engaged status.
(061) Enter Pre-engaged status via path 1, the lead pulse is determined
by the value of P5-87.
Enter Pre-engaged status via path 4, the lead pulse is determined
by the value of P5-92.
If the setting is 0, it means no lead pulse and will enter Engaged
status immediately.
Symbol +/- represents the direction of lead pulse. Please note that
the E-cam will be unable to engage if setting the wrong direction.
If setting the wrong direction, the value of monitoring variable (061) will
increase, which is far from 0 and causes overflow at the end. If it
overflows, the E-cam function will be disabled (P5-88.X=0) and the E-
cam will be forced to return to Stop status.
Function Set the relation between E-cam axis and slave axis and define it in
the E-cam table.
E-cam axis operates one cycle and the slave axis operates one
cycle.
Data Storage Data array, the start address is set by P5-81
Address of E-
Cam table
Data Format 32-bit (It has positive and negative, user unit: PUU)
E-Cam Curve It is used to magnify (minify) the E-cam shape.
Scaling It equals to the value of data multiplies P5-19.
P5-19 Switch the symbol, +/- will change the operation direction of
0 ~ +/- 32.700 slave axis.
If P5-19 is set to0, the E-cam command will not be outputted. (The
setting will be 0 for good).
Data Size It is divided into N parts via P5-82 (> = 5) and does not exceed the
limit of data array. It means 360 degrees a cycle of E-cam are
divided into N areas. Each area is (360/N) degrees.
Data Content The position data of slave axis is saved in E-cam table. (User unit:
PUU).
If E-cam is divided into N areas, the position of each area must be
included in the table. It must set N+1 points in total. It is because
the position of the first point (0 degree) and the final point (360
degree) might not be the same.
If:
1. The start and final position is the same, it means after the E-
cam operating a cycle, the slave axis returns to the origin
position.
Operation The slave axis is a virtual axis and the unit of slave position is PUU.
Description After the E-cam is engaged, the position of the master is the
entering point of P5-85. The position of the slave axis is in the
corresponding point to the P5-85 in E-cam table.
After engaging, if the master does not operate, the slave axis will
not operate. If the master operates, the slave will travel according to
the E-cam table.
For one cycle of the chart, the slave axis operates a cycle.
E-cam axis can operate in forward / reverse direction.
If the E-cam position is between two points of the E-cam table, the
position of the slave axis will be interpolated with cubic curve
function. The adjacent curve remains quadratic differential at the
point in order to smooth torque. The point amount of the table will
not influence the smoothing operation of E-cam.
Function Set the relation between slave axis and pulse command
The slave axis operates a cycle, but the pulse command might
not operate a cycle.
Description The slave axis is a virtual axis and the unit of slave position is
PUU.
The pulse command is the encoder unit (pulse). The resolution
is 1280000 pulse/rev.
For one cycle of the chart, the slave axis operates a cycle.
Setting Method If the pulse number of slave axis is L, the motor axis operates
R cycle.
P1-44: numerator
P1-45: Then, the setting of gear ratio is P1-44/P1-45=1280000 x R /
denominator L
The gear ratio of PT and PR is the same.
CAPTURE Features
Pulse Source Main encoder of the motor
Auxiliary encoder (linear scale)
Pulse command
The selected axis will be displayed in P5-37, the default value can be
written in before capture.
Note: When the source of COMPARE is CAP axis, the CAP source
cannot be changed.
Trigger signal Triggered by DI7, the response time is 5 usec.
Note: DI7 directly connects to CAPTURE hardware. Thus, regardless
the setting value of P2-16 (DI Code), CAPTURE can work. When
using CAPTURE, in order to avoid DI error, system will force to
disable DI function, which means the setting will be P2-16 =
0x0100 automatically. Since the value is not written into
EEPROM, P2-16 will return to the default value after re-power on.
CAPTURE Features
Trigger method Edge trigger can select contact A/B
It is capable to continuously capture more than one point.
It can set the trigger interval.
(The interval between this trigger and the next one.)
Data storage Data array. The start address is set by P5-36.
position
Capture number It is set via P5-38 and will not exceed the limit of data array.
Capture format 32-bit (It has positive and negative.)
Auxiliary selection After capturing the first data, the CAP axis coordinate system will
be set to the value the same as P5-76.
After capturing the first data, the COMPARE function is enabled
automatically.
After capturing all points, PR procedure#50 is triggered
automatically.
DO.CAP_OK The default value is OFF.
After capturing the last point, this DO is ON.
Set P5-39.X0 to 1 so as to activate CAPTURE function and this
DO is OFF.
Note If P5-38=0, set the value of P5-39 X, Bit0 to 1 will disable the
CAPTURE function. Clear the setting value of P5-39 X, Bit0 to 0
and set DO.CAP_OK to OFF.
Since the capture axis is 32-bit wide, the accumulation will cause
overflow. Please avoid this.
The CAP data is saved in data array and the first CAP data locates in P5-36. The CAP number
has no limit, thus it can be set via P5-38. The last CAP data is saved in P5-36+P5-38-1. Set
the value of P5-39 X, Bit0 to 1 so as to activate CAP function. Every time when DI7 is triggered,
one data will be captured and saved in data array. Then, the value of P5-38 will decrease one
automatically until the CAP number reaches the setting value (P5-38 = 0). The CAP procedure
is completed, the setting value of P5-39 X, Bit0 will be cleared to 0 and DO.CAP_OK is ON.
When capturing the first data, the position of CAP axis can be reset. The first CAP value will be
the value set by P5-76. And the value of the second CAP data will be the incremental value
from the first data. This method is called Relative Capture. If not selecting the first data reset, it
is called Absolute Capture.
When capturing the first data, it automatically activates COMPARE function, which means the
COMPARE function, is activated via DI5.
Data Storage Position Data array. The start address is set by P5-56.
Compare Number It is set via P5-58 and will not exceed the limit of data array.
Compare Format 32-bit (It has positive and negative.)
Compare Condition It will be triggered when the source of compare axis pass
through the compare value.
Auxiliary Selection Cycle mode: When comparing to the last point, it automatically
returns to the first point and starts to compare.
When the last compare is completed, the CAPTURE function is
activated automatically.
Note If P5-58 is set to 0, set the value of P5-59 X, Bit0 to1 will be
unable to compare. Set the value of P5-59 X, Bit0 to 0.
Since the capture axis is 32-bit wide, the accumulation will
cause overflow. Please avoid this.
The value of COMPARE is saved in data array and the first compare data locates in P5-56. The
CMP number has no limit, thus it can be set via P5-58. The last CMP data is saved in P5-56 +
P5-58 - 1. Set the value of P5-59 X, Bit0 to 1 so as to activate CMP function and start to compare
the first data of data array. Every time when a position saved in data array is compared, the
compare DO will be outputted. Then, the value of P5-58 will decrease one automatically and
compare the next value until the CMP number reaches the setting value (P5-58 = 0). When the
CMP procedure is completed, the setting value of P5-59 X, Bit0 will be cleared to 0.
When comparing to the last point, it can select if it returns to the first data for comparing. This is
called cycle mode. Or it can activate CAPTURE function and wait DI7 for triggering CAP/CMP
procedure.
Resonance Suppression
P2-46 DPH3 (Notch filter) Attenuation 0 dB O O O O 6.3.7
Rate (3)
Auto Resonance
P2-47 ANCF 1 N/A O O O O -
Suppression Mode Setting
Resonance Suppression
P2-48 ANCL 100 N/A O O O O -
Detection Level
Low-pass Filter of
P2-25 NLP 2 or 5 0.1ms O O O O 6.3.7
Resonance Suppression
Semi-auto Inertia
P2-33▲ INF 0 N/A O O O O 6.3.6
Adjustment
P2-49 SJIT Speed Detection Filter 0 - O O O O -
(★) Read-only register, can only read the status. For example: parameter P0-00, P0-10 and P4-00, etc.
(▲) Setting is unable when Servo On, e.g. parameter P1-00, P1-46 and P2-33, etc.
() Not effective until re-power on or off the servo drive, e.g. parameter P1-01 and P3-00.
() Parameters of no data retained setting, e.g. parameter P2-31 and P3-06.
5.6
P2-32▲ AUT2 Tuning Mode Selection 0 N/A O O O O
6.3.6
(★) Read-only register, can only read the status. For example: parameter P0-00, P0-10 and P4-00, etc.
(▲) Setting is unable when Servo On, e.g. parameter P1-00, P1-46 and P2-33, etc.
() Not effective until re-power on or off the servo drive, e.g. parameter P1-01 and P3-00.
() Parameters of no data retained setting, e.g. parameter P2-31 and P3-06.
pulse
Input Setting of Control Mode
P1-01● CTL 0 r/min O O O O 6.1
and Control Command
N-M
P1-02▲ PSTL Speed and Torque Limit Setting 0 N/A O O O O 6.6
Output Pulse Counts Per One
P1-46▲ GR3 1 pulse O O O O -
Motor Revolution
P1-55 MSPD Maximum Speed Limit rated r/min O O O O -
1000
P1-09 ~ 0.1
SP1 ~ 3 Internal Speed Command 1 ~ 3 ~ O O 6.3.1
P1-11 r/min
3000
P1-12 ~
TQ1 ~ 3 Internal Torque Limit 1 ~ 3 100 % O O O O 6.6.2
P1-14
Maximum Speed of Analog
P1-40▲ VCM rated r/min O O 6.3.4
Speed Command
Maximum Output of Analog
P1-41▲ TCM 100 % O O O O -
Torque Speed
Maximum Rotation Setting of
P1-76 AMSPD 5500 r/min O O O O -
Encoder Setting (OA, OB)
(★) Read-only register, can only read the status. For example: parameter P0-00, P0-10 and P4-00, etc.
(▲) Setting is unable when Servo On, e.g. parameter P1-00, P1-46 and P2-33, etc.
() Not effective until re-power on or off the servo drive, e.g. parameter P1-01 and P3-00.
() Parameters of no data retained setting, e.g. parameter P2-31 and P3-06.
Communication Parameter
Diagnosis Parameter
Diagnosis Parameter
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: DEC
Settings: This parameter shows the firmware version of the servo drive.
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: BCD
002:Over voltage
003:Under voltage (In default setting, the alarm occurs only when the
voltage is not enough in Servo ON status; In Servo ON status,
when it applies to power R, S, T, the alarm still will not be cleared.
Please refer to P2-66.)
004:Motor combination error (The drive corresponds to the wrong
motor)
005:Regeneration error
006:Over load
007:Over speed
010:Reserved
013:Emergency stop
016:IGBT overheat
017:Abnormal EEPROM
021:Reserved
Alarm of Motion
201:An error occurs when loading CANopen data
Address: 0004H
P0-02 STS Drive Status
0005H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.2
Default: 00
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 00 ~ 127
Format: DEC
05: Error pulse number (after the scaling of electronic gear ratio)
(Encoder unit) [Pulse]
16:IGBT temperature
38:It display the battery voltage [0.1 Volt]. For example, if it displays
36, it means the battery voltage is 3.6 V.
Address: 0006H
P0-03 MON Analog Output Monitor
0007H
Operational Related Section: 6.6.4
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 00
Unit: -
Range: 00 ~ 0x77
Format: HEX
Settings:
MON1,
MON2
Description
Setting
Value
0 Motor speed (+/-8 Volts/Max. speed)
1 Motor torque (+/-8 Volts/Max. torque)
MON1 output voltage 8 (unit:Volts)
.
MON2 output voltage 8
.
(unit: Volts)
P0-04■ ~
Reserved
P0-07■
Address: 0010H
P0-08★ TSON Power On Time
0011H
Operational Related Section:-
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
-
Mode:
Unit: Hour
Range: 0 ~ 65535
Format: DEC
Address: 0012H
P0-09★ CM1 Status Monitor Register 1
0013H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting value which is set by P0-17 should be monitored via P0-09.
(Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for
the setting value.)
Address: 0014H
P0-10★ CM2 Status Monitor Register 2
0015H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting value which is set by P0-18 should be monitored via P0-10.
(Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring variable for
the setting value.) Set P0-02 to 24, the panel displays VAR-2 first, and
then shows the content of P0-10.
Address: 0016H
P0-11★ CM3 Status Monitor Register 3
0017H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting value which is set by P0-19 should be monitored via P0-11.
(Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for
the setting value.) Set P0-02 to 25, the panel displays VAR-3 first, and
then shows the content of P0-11.
Address: 0018H
P0-12★ CM4 Status Monitor Register 4
0019H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting value which is set by P0-20 should be monitored via P0-12.
(Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for
the setting value.) Set P0-02 to 26, the panel displays VAR-4 first, and
then shows the content of P0-12.
Address: 001AH
P0-13★ CM5 Status Monitor Register 5
001BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting value which is set by P0-21 should be monitored via P0-13.
(Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for
the setting value.)
P0-14 ~
Reserved
P0-16
Address: 0022H
P0-17 CM1A Status Monitor Register 1 Selection
0023H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
-
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 127
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for the
setting value.
For example, if P0-17 is set to 07, then reading P0-09 means reading
「Motor speed (r/min) 」.
Address: 0024H
P0-18 CM2A Status Monitor Register 2 Selection
0025H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
-
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 127
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for the
setting value.
Address:0026H
P0-19 CM3A Status Monitor Register 3 Selection
0027H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
-
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 127
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for the
setting value.
Address: 0028H
P0-20 CM4A Status Monitor Register 4 Selection
0029H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
-
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 127
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for the
setting value.
Address: 002AH
P0-21 CM5A Status Monitor Register 5 Selection
002BH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
-
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 127
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to Chapter 7.2.1, Description of Monitoring Variable for the
setting value.
P0-22 ~
Reserved
P0-24
Address: 0032H
P0-25 MAP1 Mapping Parameter # 1
0033H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: Users can rapidly continuously read and write parameters that are not
in the same group. The content of parameter that is specified by P0-35
will be shown in P0-25.
Please refer to the description of P0-35 for parameter setting.
Address: 0034H
P0-26 MAP2 Mapping Parameter # 2
0035H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: The using method is the same as P0-25. The mapping target is set by
parameter P0-36.
Address: 0036H
P0-27 MAP3 Mapping Parameter # 3
0037H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: The using method is the same as P0-25. The mapping target is set by
parameter P0-37.
Address: 0038H
P0-28 MAP4 Mapping Parameter # 4
0039H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: The using method is the same as P0-25. The mapping target is set by
parameter P0-38.
Address: 003AH
P0-29 MAP5 Mapping Parameter # 5
003BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: The using method is the same as P0-25. The mapping target is set by
parameter P0-39.
Address: 003CH
P0-30 MAP6 Mapping Parameter # 6
003DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: The using method is the same as P0-25. The mapping target is set by
parameter P0-40.
Address: 003EH
P0-31 MAP7 Mapping Parameter # 7
003FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: The using method is the same as P0-25. The mapping target is set by
parameter P0-41.
Address: 0040H
P0-32 MAP8 Mapping Parameter # 8
0041H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: The using method is the same as P0-25. The mapping target is set by
parameter P0-42.
P0-33 ~
Reserved
P0-34
Address: 0046H
P0-35 MAP1A Target Setting of Mapping Parameter P0-25
0047H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.3.5
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
ngs: Selec
Settin ct the data b
block to acc
cess the parameter corrresponded d by
register 1.
The mapping
m co
ontent is 32 bits wide and can mapp to two 16--bit
parammeters or o ne 32-bit pa
arameter.
P0-35:
Ad
ddress: 004
48H
P0-36 MAP2A
A Target Setting
S of M
Mapping Pa
arameter P0-26
00
049H
Operaational Reelated Section:
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Ad
ddress: 004
4AH
P0-37 MAP3A
A Target Setting
S of M
Mapping Pa
arameter P0-27
00
04BH
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-29
9
Chapter 8 P
Parameters ASDA-A2
2
Ad
ddress: 004
4CH
P0-38 MAP4A
A Target Setting
S of M
Mapping Pa
arameter P0-28
00
04DH
Operaational Reelated Section:
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Ad
ddress: 004
4EH
P0-39 MAP5A
A Target Setting
S of M
Mapping Pa
arameter P0-29
00
04FH
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Ad
ddress: 005
50H
P0-40 MAP6A
A Target Setting
S of M
Mapping Pa
arameter P0-30
00
051H
Operaational Reelated Section:
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Ad
ddress: 005
52H
P0-41 MAP7A
A Target Setting
S of M
Mapping Pa
arameter P0-31
00
053H
Operaational Reelated Section:
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bitt
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-31
Chapter 8 P
Parameters ASDA-A2
2
Ad
ddress: 005
54H
P0-42 MAP8A
A Target Setting
S of M
Mapping Pa
arameter P0-32
00
055H
Operaational Reelated Section:
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
P0-43 Reserve
ed
Ad
ddress: 005
58H
★
P0-44★ PCMN
N Status Monitor
M Reg
gister (for PC software)
00
059H
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 4.33.5
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: deterrmined by th
Ran he commun
nication add
dress of
the parameter
p g roup
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: DEC
Form
ngs: Same
Settin e as param eter P0-09.
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0~127
Format: DEC
Address: 005CH
P0-46★ SVSTS Servo Digital Output Status Display
005DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Adddress: 00662H
P0-49■
■ UAP Renew Encoder
E Ab
bsolute Po
osition
00
063H
Operaational Reelated Section: N/A
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: N/A
Data Size:
S 16-bit
mat: Hexa
Form adecimal
Setttings:This
s parameterr is used to renew the absolute
a poosition data of the
enco
oder.
Param
meter Rene
ew Setting:
1: Re
enew the en
ncoder data
a to parametters P0-50~
~P0-52 only
y.
2: Reenew the pa arameters P0-50~P0-5
P 52, and cleaar the positioon error as
weell. While th
his setting is
s activated, the currentt position off the motor
will be reset a
as the target position off position coommand (sa ame
fun
nction as CC CLR).
Adddress: 00664H
P0-50★
★ APSTS
S Absolute Coordina
ate System
m Status
00
065H
Operaational Reelated Section: N/A
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: N/A
Data Size:
S 16-bit
mat: Hexa
Form adecimal
Settin
ngs:
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
Bit 15 Bit 14
4 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 110 Bit 9 Bit 8
Address: 0066H
P0-51★ APR Encoder Absolute Position (Multiturn)
0067H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: rev
Format: Decimal
Settings: While the Bit 1 of P2-70 is set to read the encoder pulse number, this
parameter represents the turns of encoder absolute position. While the
Bit 1 of P2-70 is set to read the PUU number, this parameter becomes
disabled and the setting value of this parameter is 0.
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: Pulse
e or PUU
Ran 280000-1 (P
nge: 0~12 Pulse Numb
ber);
-2147
7483648 ~ 214748364
47 (PUU)
Data Size:
S 32-bit
mat: Decim
Form mal
Setttings:Whille the Bit 1 of P2-70 is set to read the pulse nnumber, this
s
para
ameter repre esents the pulse
p numbber of encodder absolutee position.
Whille the Bit 1 of P2-70 is set to read the PUU n umber, this parameter
repre
esents PUU U number of motor abs solute positioon.
General Range Co
ompare Digital Outputt – Ad
ddress: 006
6AH
P0-53 ZDRT
T
Filtering
g Time 00
06BH
Operaational Reelated Section: N/A
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0x0000
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: ms
Data Size:
S 16-bit
mat: Hexa
Form adecimal
Settin
ngs:
ault: 0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: -2147
Ran 7483648 ~ +21474836
647
Data Size:
S 32-bit
mat: Decim
Form mal
Settin
ngs:The va
alue of para
ameter P0-009 will change within thhe range be etween P0-
54 and
d P0-55 andd then outpu
ut after the filtering tim e determine
ed by
param
meter P0-53..
ault: 0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: -2147
Ran 7483648 ~ +21474836
647
Data Size:
S 32-bit
mat: Decim
Form mal
Setting
gs: The va
alue of para meter P0-09 will changge within thee range bettween P0-
54 and
d P0-55 andd then outpu
ut after the filtering
f timee determine
ed by
parameeter P0-53.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-37
7
Chapter 8 Parameters ASDA-A2
P0-56 ~
Reserved
P0-62
Address: 007EH
P0-63 VGT The Time when Voltage Exceeding 400V
007FH
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: ms
Format: DEC
Settings: Record the accumulative time when the drive’s voltage exceeding
400V.
P1-xx Ba
asic Param
meters
Ad
ddress: 010
00H
P1-00▲
▲ PTT The Typ
pe of Extern
nal Pulse In
nput
01
101H
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 6.22.1
ault: 0x2
Defa
Control
PT
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: 0 ~ 0x1132
Ran 0
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
Pulsse Type
0: AB
A phase pu ulse (4x)
1: Clockwise
C (CCW) and Coounterclockw
wise (CCW
W) pulse
2: Pulse
P + sym bol
Otheer setting: rreserved
Filte
er Width
If th
he received
d frequency y is much higher
h than the setting
g, it will be
e
rega d filtered out.
arded as th e noise and
Setting
S Low
w-speed filtter frequenc
cy g High-speeed filter fre
Setting equency
V
Value (M
Min. pulse w
width*note1) Value (Min. puulse width*n note1)
0 0.83Mppss (600ns) 0 3.333Mpps (150ns)
1 208Kppss (2.4us) 1 0.833Mpps (600ns)
2 104Kppss (4.8us) 2 4166Kpps (1.2u
us)
3 52Kpps (9.6us) 3 2088Kpps (2.4u
us)
4 No filter ffunction 4 No filter functio
on
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-39
9
Chapter 8 Parameters ASDA-A2
Note: When the source of external pulse is from the high-speed differential signal
and the setting value is 0 (the high-speed filter frequency is 3.33Mpps at the
moment), then:
If the user uses 2~4 MHz input pulse, it is suggested to set the filter value to 4.
Please note that the applicable version is: DSP version 1.036 sub05 and CPLD
version above 10.
Note: When the signal is the high-speed pulse specification of 4 Mpps and the
settings value of the filter is 4, then pulse will not be filtered.
Logic Type
AB phase
Positive Logic
pulse
0
CW and
CCW
pulse
Positive Logic
Pulse +
0
Symbol
Pulse +
0
Symbol
For digital circuit, it uses 0 and 1 represents two status, which is high voltage and low
voltage. In Positive Logic, 1 represents high voltage and 0 represents low voltage
and vice versa in Negative Logic.
For example:
Positive Logic
Negative Logic
Range: 00 ~ 0x110F
Format: HEX
Settings:
Mode PT PR S T Sz Tz
0D ▲ ▲
Multiple Mode
0E ▲ ▲ ▲
0F ▲ ▲ ▲ 0F
F
Dual Mode e: It can switch mode via v the exteernal Digitall Input (DI)..
For examp ple, if it is set to the duual mode oof PT/S (Co ontrol mode e
setting: 06)), the mode can be switched via D DI. S-P (Pleaase refer to
o
table 8.1).
Multiple Mo ode: It can switch mo ode via the external Digital
D Inputt
(DI). For exxample, if itt is set to multiple
m modde of PT/PR
R/S (Controll
Mode Setti ng: 12), the e mode can n be switcheed via DI. S-P,
S PT-PR R
(Please refefer to table 8.1).
8
Torque Outtput Directio
on Settings
0 1
Forward
Reverse
Digital Inpu
ut / Digital Output
O (DIO)) Setting
0: When sw witching mo ode, DIO (P2-10 ~ P2-222) remains s the
original ssetting valu
ue and will not
n be chan ged.
1: When sw witching mo ode, DIO (P2-10 ~ P2-222) can be reset to the
e
default vvalue of eacch operationnal mode auutomatically
y.
Ad
ddress: 010
04H
P1-02▲
▲ PSTL
L Speed and
a Torque
e Limit Settting
01
105H
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: Seection 6.6
Taable 8.1
ault: 0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: 00 ~ 0x11
Ran
Data Size:
S 16bit
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-43
3
Chapter 8 Parameters ASDA-A2
Format: HEX
Settings:
Address: 0106H
P1-03 AOUT Polarity Setting of Encoder Pulse Output
0107H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 3.3.3
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x13
Format: HEX
Settings:
Not in use
Address: 0108H
P1-04 MON1 MON1 Analog Monitor Output Proportion
0109H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.4.4
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to parameter P0-03 for the setting of analog output
selection.
For example:
P0-03 = 0x00 (MON1 is the speed analog output)
When the output voltage value of MON1 is V1:
Motor speed = (Max. speed ×V1/8) ×P1-04/100
Address: 0108H
P1-05 MON2 MON2 Analog Monitor Output Proportion
0109H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.4.4
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Settings: Please refer to parameter P0-03 for the setting of analog output
selection.
For example: P0-03 = 0x00 (MON2 is the speed analog output)
When the output voltage value of MON2 is V2: Motor speed = (Max. ×
V2/8) ×P1-05/100
Address: 010CH
P1-06 SFLT Analog Speed Command (Low-pass Filter)
010DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.3
Default: 0
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Format: DEC
Settings: 0: Disabled
Address: 010EH
P1-07 TFLT Analog Torque Command (Low-pass Filter)
010FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.4.3
Default: 0
Control
T
Mode:
Unit: ms
Format: DEC
Settings: 0: Disabled
Default: 0
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: 10 ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Example: 11 = 110 ms
Settings: 0: Disabled
Default: 1000
Control
S/T
Mode:
Unit: 0.1rpm
Format: DEC
Default: 2000
Control
S/T
Mode:
Unit: 0.1rpm
Format: DEC
1000
-100 ~ 100 r/min 100 r/min -100 r/min
-1000
Default: 3000
Control
S/T
Mode:
Unit: 0.1rpm
Format: DEC
1000
-100 ~ 100 r/min 100 r/min -100 r/min
-1000
Default: 100
Control
T/P, S
Mode:
Unit: %
Format: DEC
Settings: Internal Torque Command 1: The setting of the first internal torque
command
Internal Torque Limit 1: The setting of the first internal torque limit
30
-30 ~ 30 % 30 % -30 %
-30
Default: 100
Control
T/P, S
Mode:
Unit: %
Format: DEC
30
-30 ~ 30 % 30 % -30 %
-30
Default: 100
Control
T/P, S
Mode:
Unit: %
Format: DEC
30
-30 ~ 30 % 30 % -30 %
-30
Default: 0000h
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
nge: 0000
Ran 0h ~ 0x1F5F
F
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: HEX
Form
Settin
ngs:
YX: Threshold
T o
of correctionn (%)
Z: Filter intensityy
U: Filter is functiioning (read
d-only)
(It will be provideed after the
e version of V1.0.38 su b15)
YX: When syn chronous axis a capturres the siggnal, the system
s willl
calculate
c th e error. This function is enabled only when the error iss
less than th
he setting ra
ange. Otherw wise, the syystem will use
u the new
w
threshold
t off correction to perform the operatioon.
YX
X 00 01~005F
Func
ction D isabled It will be enabled
e wheen error is between
b
1% and YX%.
Z 0 1~F
Func
ction D isabled Averag
ge of 2^Z: E
Enabled
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: DEC
Settings: When this function is enabled (P1-36 = 1), the system will make the
position error (PUU) close to 0 according to the compensation amount
of command. If the time delay is caused by other reasons, users could
setup the additional compensation time to compensate the position
error.
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: Decimal
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Data Size:
S 16-bit
Format: Hexa
adecimal
Settings:
Adddress: 01228H
P1-20
0 CPMK
K CAPTUR
RE – Mask ing Range Setting
0129H
Operaational Reelated Section: N/A
Pane
el/Software Com
mmunication
Interfface:
Deffault: 0
Control
C
ALL
Mo
ode:
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-55
5
Chapter 8 Parameters ASDA-A2
Range: 0 ~ +100000000
Data
32-bit
Size:
Format: Decimal
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: Decimal
Address: 012CH
P1-22 SPF1 PR Special Filter Settings
012DH
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel/Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 000h
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Settings:YX: Acceleration time limit (0: Disabled, [1~127] x 10ms), Units: 10ms
Z: Reserved
U: Reverse inhibit (0: Disabled; 1: Enabled)
YX: The acceleration time limit is 0 ~ 1270 ms. When the changes of
PR (or E-Cam) commands are too fast, it will cause the vibration of
the mechanical system and affect the system performance. This
function can be used to control the acceleration (deceleration)
speed without exceeding the limit and can smooth the operation,
reduce the noise and extend the system life.
This function is different from the general filter. The traditional one
filter the command regardless the command change. This causes
the delay of command delivered and reduces the efficiency of the
system. This function can help to disable the filter function when
the command changes within the limit. Then, the commands can
be delivered without any time delay. The definition of this setting is
the required acceleration time when the motor runs from 0 to 3000
r/min. The required time is longer, the effect of the filter function is
better and the acceleration / deceleration will become smoother.
Please note:
The unit of acceleration time limit is 10ms. For example, if YX=12h,
the acceleration time limit is 180ms. It means the filter function is
enabled when the acceleration or deceleration time is faster than
180ms. Otherwise, the command will remain unchanged.
Original Command
Filtered Command
Speed
Command
(PUU/ms)
Time
Normal Commands Overexcited
Two commands are Commands
overlapped. Filter function is
enabled.
Note: When this filter function is enabled, it may cause the motor goes beyond
the original position. Usually, the motor will return to the original position
after the command becomes stable. However, if the command does not
become stable, the internal position errors may be accumulated and
result in AL.404.
Note: The filter time has to be set properly. It should be shorter than the
acceleration time and longer than the abnormal command.
Note: The function of U item can be used to avoid the reverse operation.
U: Reverse Inhibit Function (0: Disable the function; 1: enable the function)
When this reverse inhibit function is enabled, the reverse command will be
inhibited. The reverse command will be reserved and output after the received
forward command exceeds the reserved reverse command.
Position
Command
(PUU)
Time
Reverse inhibit
function is enabled
Position
Command
After reverse inhibit
(PUU) function is enabled
Time
Address: 012EH
P1-23 CMOF COMPARE-Offset Data of CMP (non-volatile)
012FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: DEC
Settings:
The real compared data is offset by this value.
CMP_DATA = DATA_ARRAY[*] + P1-23 + P1-24
Address: 0132H
P1-25 VSF1 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (1)
0133H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 1000
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: 0.1 Hz
Range: 10 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Example: 150= 15 Hz
Settings: The setting value of the first low-frequency vibration suppression. If P1-
26 is set to 0, then it will disable the first low-frequency filter.
Default: 0
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The first low-frequency vibration suppression gain. The bigger value it
is, the better the position response will be. However, if the value is set
too big, the motor will not be able to smoothly operate. It is suggested
to set the value to 1.
Address: 0136H
P1-27 VSF2 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (2)
0137H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 1000
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: 0.1 Hz
Range: 10 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Example: 150 = 15 Hz
Address: 0138H
P1-28 VSG2 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (2)
0139H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 0
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The second low-frequency vibration suppression gain. The bigger value
it is, the better the position response will be. However, if the value is set
too big, the motor will not be able to smoothly operate. It is suggested to
set the value to 1.
Default: 0
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 1
Format: DEC
Address: 013CH
P1-30 VCL Low-frequency Vibration Detection
013DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.9
Default: 500
Control
PT / PR
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
Range: 1 ~ 8000
Format: DEC
Settings: When enabling the auto suppression (P1-29 = 1), it will automatically
search the detection level. The lower the value is, the more sensitive
the detection will be. However, it is easy to misjudge the noise or
regard the other low-frequency vibration as the suppression frequency.
If the value is bigger, it will make more precise judgment. However, if
the vibration of the mechanism is smaller, it might not detect the
frequency of low-frequency vibration.
P1-31 Reserved
Address: 0140H
P1-32 LSTP Motor Stop Mode
0141H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x20
Format: HEX
Settings:
Not in use
Selection of executing dynamic brake
Not in use
P1-33 Reserved
Address: 0144H
P1-34 TACC Acceleration Constant of S-Curve
0145H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.3
Default: 200
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
NOTE 1)When the source of speed command is analog, and P1-36 is set to
0, it will disable S-curve function.
2)When the source of speed command is analog, the max. range of
P1-34 will be set within 20000 automatically.
Address: 0146H
P1-35 TDEC Deceleration Constant of S-Curve
0147H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.3
Default: 200
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
NOTE 1)When the source of speed command is analog, and P1-36 is set to
0, it will disable S-curve function.
2)When the source of speed command is analog, the max. range of
P1-35 will be set within 20000 automatically.
Default: 0
Control
S, PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
mat: DEC
Form
ngs: Acce
Settin eleration / D eceleration Constant of
o S-Curve:
P1-34
4: Set the a
acceleration
n time of acc
celeration / deceleratio
on of
trapezoid
d-curve
P1-35
5: Set the d
deceleration
n time of acc
celeration / deceleratio
on of
trapezoid
d-curve
P1-36
6: Set the ssmoothing tiime of S-curve accelerration and
decelerattion
P1-344, P1-35 an nd P1-36 can
c be set individually . Even whe en P1-36 iss
set to
o 0, it still ha ation / deceleration of trrapezoid-cu
as accelera urve.
NO
OTE 1)W
When the so
ource of spe
eed command is analogg, and P1-3
36 is set to
0, it will disab
ble S-curve
e function.
When the so
2)W ource of speeed command is analogg, the max. range of
P1-36
P will be
e set within 10000 auto
omatically.
Inertia Ratio
R and L
Load Weig o Servo Ad
ght Ratio to ddress: 014
4AH
P1-37 GDR
Motor 01
14BH
Operaational Reelated Section: -
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 1.0
Defa 10
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: 1time
es 0.1ttimes
Data Size:
S 16bit
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-65
5
Chapter 8 Parameters ASDA-A2
Address: 014CH
P1-38 ZSPD Zero Speed Range Setting
014DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Settings: Setting the output range of zero-speed signal (ZSPD). When the
forward / reverse speed of the motor is slower than the setting value,
the digital output will be enabled.
Address: 014EH
P1-39 SSPD Target Motor Detection Level
014FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Default: 3000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: r/min
Range: 0 ~ 5000
Format: DEC
Address: 0150H
P1-40▲ VCM Maximum Output of Analog Speed Command
0151H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.4
Unit: r/min
Range: 0 ~ 5000
Format: DEC
Address: 0152H
P1-41▲ TCM Maximum Output of Analog Torque Speed
0153H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.4.4
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Address: 0154H
P1-42 MBT1 Enable Delay Time of Brake
0155H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.5.5
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Settings: Set the delay time from servo ON to activate the signal of mechanical
brake (BRKR).
Address: 0156H
P1-43 MBT2 Disable Delay Time of Brake
0157H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.5.5
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: ms
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
NO
OTE 1)If the delay t ime of P1-4
43 has not finished yet and the mo
otor speed
s slower tha
is an P1-38, th
he signal of brake (BRK
KR) will be disabled.
d
2)If the delay t ime of P1-4
43 is up and
d the motor speed is higher than
P1-38,
P the s ignal of brake (BRKR) will be disaabled.
3) When
W Servo
o OFF due to t Alarm (ex xcept AL0222) or emerg gency, the
se
etting of P1 -43 is equiv
valent to 0 if P1-43 is sset to a negative
va
alue.
Ad
ddress: 015
58H
P1-44▲
▲ GR1 Gear Ra
atio (Numerrator) (N1)
01
159H
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 6.22.5
ault: 1
Defa
Control
PT/PR
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: Pulse
e
229-1)
nge: 1 ~ (2
Ran
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: DEC
Form
Settin se refer to
ngs: Pleas o P2-60~P2
2-62 for the setting oof multiple gear ratio
o
(num
merator).
Ad
ddress: 015
5AH
P1-45 GR2 Gear Ra
atio (Denom
minator) (M
M)
01
15BH
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 6.22.5
ault: 1
Defa
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-69
9
Chapter 8 Parameters ASDA-A2
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
31
Range: 1 ~ (2 -1)
Format: DEC
Settings: If the setting is wrong, the servo motor will easily have sudden
unintended acceleration.
Please follow the rules for setting:
The setting of pulse input:
Address: 015CH
P1-46▲ GR3 Pulse Number of Encoder Output
015DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 2500
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
Range: 20 ~ 320000
Format: DEC
NOTE The following circumstances might exceed the max. allowable input
pulse frequency and occurs AL018:
1. Abnormal encoder
2. The motor speed is faster than the setting of P1-76.
Motor Speed
3. P1 46 4 19.8 10 6
60
Ad
ddress: 015
5EH
P1-47 SPOK
K Speed Reached
R (D
DO:SP_OK
K) Range
01
15FH
Operaational Reelated Section: -
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 10
Defa
Control
S / Sz
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: r/min
nge: 0 ~ 300
Ran 3
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
ngs: When
Settin n the devia
ation betweeen speed command and moto or feedbackk
speed is sma aller than this param meter, thenn the digital outputt
DO.S
SP_OK (DO O code is 0x
x19) is ON.
Block
k diagram:
1. Spe
eed comma and: It is the
t comma and issued by the user (withoutt
acc
celeration / d
deceleration
n), not the one
o of front end speed circuit.
Souurce: Analog g voltage annd register
2. Feeedback spe eed: The actual
a speed of the m motor and have gone e
thro
ough the filte
er.
3. Obta
ain the abso olute value..
4. DO.SP_OK wiill be ON when w the absolute
a vaalue of spe
eed error iss
smaaller than PP1-47, or itt will be OF FF. If P1-447 is 0, DO
O.SP_OK iss
always OFF.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-71
Chapter 8 P
Parameters ASDA-A2
2
Operatio
on Selecttion of Motion
M Reached
R Ad
ddress: 016
60H
P1-48 MCOK
K
(DO.MC__OK) 01
161H
Operaational Reelated Section: -
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0x0000
Defa
Control
PR
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: HEX
Form
Description:
1. Coommand trig ggered: It means
m the new
n PR com mmand is efffective.
Poosition com mand starts s to output and
a clear siignal 2, 4, 5,
5 6 at the
sa
ame time.
2. CMMD_OK: It mmeans the position com mmand is ccompletely outputted
o
nd can set t he delay tim
an me (DLY).
3. Command
C o utput: Outpput the profile of positioon commandd
ac
ccording to tthe setting acceleration / deceleraation.
4. TPOS: It means the position error of the servo drive is smaller than
the value of P1-54.
5. MC_OK: It means the position command is completely outputted and
the position error of the servo drive is smaller than P1-54.
6. MC_OK (remains the digital output status): It is the same as 5.
However, once this DO is ON, its status will be remained regardless
signal 4 is OFF or not.
7. The output profile is determined by parameter P1-48.X.
8. Position Deviation: When number 7 happens, if 4 (or 5) is OFF, it
means the position is deviated and AL380 can be triggered. Set this
alarm via parameter P1-48.Y.
Address: 0162H
P1-49 SPOKWT Accumulative Time of Speed Reached
0163H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication Table 8.2
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
S/Sz
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 65535
Format: DEC
Settings: In speed mode, when the deviation value between speed command
and motor feedback speed is smaller than the range set by P1-47
and reaches the time set by P1-79, DO.SP_OK will be On. If the
deviation value exceeds the range set by P1-47, it has to reclock the
time.
P1-50 ~
Reserved
P1-51
Address: 0168H
P1-52 RES1 Regenerative Resistor Value
0169H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 2.7
Unit: Ohm
Range: 220V
Setting
Model
Range
400W (included) or
30~750
below
750W ~ 1.5kW 20~750
2kW~4.5kW 10~750
5.5 W 8~750
7.5kW 5~750
11kW~15kW 3~750
Format: DEC
Settings:
Model Default
1.5 kW (included) or below 40Ω
2 kW ~ 4.5 kW (included) 20Ω
5.5 kW 15Ω
7.5 kW 15Ω
Please refer to the description of P1-53 for the setting value when
connecting regenerative resistor with different method.
Address: 016AH
P1-53 RES2 Regenerative Resistor Capacity
016BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 2.7
Unit: Watt
Range: 0 ~ 6000
(for 11kW, 15kW, the setting range is from 0
to 15000)
Data Size: 16-bit
Format: DEC
Settings:
Model Default
1.5 kW (included) or below 60W
2 kW ~ 4.5 kW (included) 100W
5.5 kW 0W
7.5 kW 0W
Setting:
P1-52=10 (Ω)
P -53=1000 (W)
Setting:
P1-52=20 (Ω)
P1-53=2000 (W)
Setting:
P1-52=5 (Ω)
P1-53=2000 (W)
Address: 016CH
P1-54 PER Position Completed Range
016DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Default: 12800
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
Range: 0 ~ 1280000
Format: DEC
Settings: In position mode (PT), if the deviation pulse number is smaller than the
setting range (the setting value of parameter P1-54), DO.TPOS is ON.
In position register (PR) mode, if the deviation between the target
position and the actual motor position is smaller than the setting range
(the setting value of parameter P1-54), DO.TPOS is ON.
Address: 016EH
P1-55 MSPD Maximum Speed Limit
016FH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Unit: r/min
Range: 0 ~ max.speed
Format: DEC
Settings: The default of the max. speed of servo motor is set to the rated speed.
Address: 0170H
P1-56 OVW Output Overload Warning Level
0171H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 120
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 120
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting value is 0 ~ 100, if the servo motor continuously outputs
the load and is higher than the setting proportion (P1-56), the early
warning for overload (DO is set to 10, OLW) will occur.
If the setting value is over 100, it will disable this function.
Address: 0172H
P1-57 CRSHA Motor Crash Protection (torque percentage)
0173H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 300
Format: DEC
Settings: Setup protection level (for the percentage of rated torque, set the value
to 0 means to disable the function, set the value to 1 or number above
means to enable the function)
Address: 0174H
P1-58 CRSHT Motor Crash Protection Time
0175H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Address: 0176H
P1-59 MFLT Analog Speed Command
0177H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0.0 0
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: 1 ms 0.1 ms
Holding Time
P1-60 ~
Reserved
P1-61
Address: 017CH
P1-62 FRCL Friction Compensation
017DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PT/PR/S
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Settings: The level of friction compensation (the percentage of rated torque. Set
the value to 0 means to disable the function; set the value to 1 or
number above means to enable it.)
Address: 017EH
P1-63 FRCT Friction Compensation
017FH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PT/PR/S
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Default: 0x00
Control
PT
Mode:
Unit: --
Range: 0 x00
0~ 0x11
Data Size:
S 32-bit
Format: HEX
X
Settings:
X:
0: Disable
D the function of position command wh ich is issue ed by
analog
a
1: Enable
E the ffunction of position com mmand whiich is issued d by
analog
a
Y: Initial positio
on setting
0: After
A servoo on, the motor
m will re
egard the ccurrent position as thee
position
p whe en the volta
age is 0. Th hen the mootor will ope
erate to the
e
position
p acccording to th
he command d issued byy analog inp
put.
Motor positio
on (Turn)
When executing g
this function, the
motor will operatte
to the position
which corresponds
to the current
voltage comman nd
Anaalog
See the curreent inp
put
position as th
he Current commmand
position when co
ommand (V
V)
voltage is 0 level
1: After SERVO
O ON, if the e command d level is noot changed, the motorr
will
w not ope rate. The position
p the motor stopps is the position thatt
corresponds
c s to the currrent commaand level.
Z: Reserved
U: Reserved
Address: 0182H
P1-65 Smooth Constant of Analog Position Command
0183H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel/Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1
Control
PT
Mode:
Unit: 10 ms
Range: 1 ~ 1000
Format: Decimal
Settings: The smooth constant of analog position command is only effective to
analog position command.
Default: 1.0
Control Mode: PT
Range: 0 ~ 2000
F
Format: One decimal DE
EC
Exxample: 15
5 =1.5 cycle
es
P1-67 Reserve
ed
Ad
ddress: 018
88H
P1-68 PFLT2
2 Position
n Command
d Moving Filter
F
01
189H
Operaational Reelated Section: -
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 4
Defa
Control
PT/PR
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: ms
nge: 0 ~ 100
Ran
Data Size:
S 16bit
mat: DEC
Form
ngs: 0: Dis
Settin sabled
Moving Filter ca n activate smooth
s func
ction in
the beginning
b annd the end of
o step com
mmand,
but it will delay tthe comman nd.
P1-69 ~
Reserve
ed
P1-71
Default: 5000
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: pulse/rev
Format: DEC
Settings: A/B pulse corresponded by full-closed loop when motor runs a cycle
(after quadruple frequency)
Default: 30000
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Format: DEC
Address: 0194H
P1-74▲ FCON Full-closed Loop Control of Linear Scale
0195H
Operational Related Section: P1-46
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1000h
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings:
Default: 100
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Settings: When the stiffness of mechanical system between full- and half-closed
loops is insufficient, users can setup the appropriate time constant to
enhance the stability of the system.
Set the value to 0 to disable the function of low-pass filter (Bypass)
The stiffness of mechanical system ↑, the setting value of P1-75 ↓
The stiffness of mechanical system ↓, the setting value of P1-75 ↑
Default: 5500
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: r/min
Range: 0 ~ 6000
Format: DEC
Settings: According to the real application, this parameter is set for the maximum
speed and the servo drive will generate smooth function automatically
for encoder output signals.
When the value is set to 0, the function is disabled.
P1-77 ~
Reserved
P1-80
Address: 01A2H
P1-81 VCM2 Max. Speed of 2nd Analog Speed Command
01A3H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: P1-40
Unit: rpm/10V
Range: 0 ~ 50000
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: msec
Format: DEC
Settings: 0: Disabled
Address: 01A6H
P1-83 VCMLPF Abnormal Analog Input Voltage Level
01A7H
Operational Related Section:
Panel/Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: mV
Format: Decimal
Settings: When analog input voltage is over 50ms, AL.042 will occur. The
compared level for this parameter is the original analog input voltage
which has not been added by an offset value via parameter P4-22,
Analog Speed Input Offset.
Address: 01A8H
P1-87 HMTQL Torque Limit Setting
01A9H
Operational Related Section:
Panel/Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 1~300
Format: DEC
Address: 01AAH
P1-88 HMTQT Torque Limit Time Setting
01ABH
Operational Related Section:
Panel/Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 2000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 2~2000
Format: DEC
Address: 0200H
P2-00 KPP Position Loop Gain
0201H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.8
Default: 35
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: rad/s
Range: 0 ~ 2047
Format: DEC
Settings: When the value of position loop gain is increased, the position
response can be enhanced and the position error can be reduced. If
the value is set too big, it may easily cause vibration and noise.
Address: 0202H
P2-01 PPR Switching Rate of Position Loop Gain
0203H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.8
Default: 100
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 10 ~ 500
Format: DEC
Settings: Switch the changing rate of position loop gain according to the gain-
switching condition.
Address: 0204H
P2-02 PFG Position Feed Forward Gain
0205H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.2.8
Default: 50
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Default: 5
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 2 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Address: 0208H
P2-04 KVP Speed Loop Gain
0209H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.6
Default: 500
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: rad/s
Range: 0 ~ 8191
Format: DEC
Settings: Increase the value of speed loop gain can enhance the speed
response. However, if the value is set too big, it would easily cause
resonance and noise.
Address: 020AH
P2-05 SPR Switching Rate of Speed Loop Gain
020BH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 10 ~ 500
Format: DEC
Settings: Switch the changing rate of speed loop gain according to the gain
switching condition.
Address: 020CH
P2-06 KVI Speed Integral Compensation
020DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.6
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: rad/s
Range: 0 ~ 1023
Format: DEC
Address: 020EH
P2-07 KVF Speed Feed Forward Gain
020FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.6
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 100
Format: DEC
Settings: When the speed control command runs smoothly, increasing the gain
value can reduce the speed command error. If the command does not
run smoothly, decreasing the gain value can reduce the mechanical
vibration during operation.
Address: 0210H
P2-08■ PCTL Special Parameter Write-in
0211H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 65535
Format: DEC
20 P4-10 is writable
22 P4-11~P4-21are writable
Address: 0212H
P2-09 DRT DI Debouncing Time
0213H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 2
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 20
Format: DEC
Settings: When the environmental noise is big, increasing the setting value can
enhance the control stability. However, if the value is set too big, the
response time will be influenced.
Address: 0214H
P2-10 DI1 DI1 Functional Planning
0215H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 101
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings:
Not in use
Address: 0216H
P2-11 DI2 DI2 Functional Planning
0217H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 104
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0218H
P2-12 DI3 DI3 Functional Planning
0219H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 116
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 021AH
P2-13 DI4 DI4 Functional Planning
021BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 117
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 021CH
P2-14 DI5 DI5 Functional Planning
021DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 102
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 021EH
P2-15 DI6 DI6 Functional Planning
021FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 22
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0220H
P2-16 DI7 DI7 Functional Planning
0221H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 23
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0222H
P2-17 DI8 DI8 Functional Planning
0223H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 21
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0224H
P2-18 DO1 DO1 Functional Planning
0225H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Default: 101
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings:
Not in use
Address: 0226H
P2-19 DO2 DO2 Functional Planning
0227H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Default: 103
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0228H
P2-20 DO3 DO3 Functional Planning
0229H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Default: 109
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 022AH
P2-21 DO4 DO4 Functional Planning
022BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Default: 105
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 022CH
P2-22 DO5 DO5 Functional Planning
022DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.2
Default: 7
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 022EH
P2-23 NCF1 Resonance Suppression (Notch filter) (1)
022FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.7
Default: 1000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Hz
Range: 50 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Settings: The first setting value of resonance frequency. If P2-24 is set to 0, this
function is disabled. P2-43 and P2-44 are the second Notch filter.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: dB
Format: DEC
Settings: The first resonance suppression (notch filter) attenuation rate. When
this parameter is set to 0, the function of Notch filter is disabled.
NOTE If the value of attenuation rate is set to 5, then, it would be -5dB.
Address: 0232H
P2-25 NLP Low-pass Filter of Resonance Suppression
0233H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.7
Unit: 1 ms 0.1 ms
Settings: Set the low-pass filter of resonance suppression. When the value is set
to 0, the function of low-pass filter is disabled.
Address: 0234H
P2-26 DST Anti-interference Gain
0235H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: 1
Format: DEC
Settings: Increasing the value of this parameter can increase the damping of speed
loop. It is suggested to set P2-26 equals to the value of P2-06. If users
desire to adjust P2-26, please follow the rules below.
1. In speed mode, increase the value of this parameter can reduce
speed overshoot.
2. In position mode, decrease the value of this parameter can reduce
position overshoot.
Address: 0236H
P2-27 GCC Gain Switching and Switching Selection
0237H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings:
Not in use
Address: 0238H
P2-28 GUT Gain Switching Time Constant
0239H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 10
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: 10ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Example: 15 = 150 ms
Settings: It is for switching the smooth gain. (0: disable this function)
Address: 023AH
P2-29 GPE Gain Switching
023BH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1280000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 3840000
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting of gain switching (Pulse error, Kpps, r/min) is determined
by the selection of gain switching (P2-27).
Address: 023CH
P2-30■ INH Auxiliary Function
023DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -8 ~ +8
Format: DEC
NOTE Please set the value to 0 in normal operation. The value returns to 0
automatically after re-power on.
Default: 80
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Hz
Range: 1 ~ 0x1000
Format: HEX
NOTE 1)According to the speed loop setting of P2-31, the servo drive sets
the position loop response automatically.
2)The function is enabled via parameter P2-32. Please refer to
Chapter 5.6 for corresponding bandwidth size of the setting value.
Address: 0240H
P2-32▲ AUT2 Tuning Mode Selection
0241H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 5.6 and 6.3.6
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x2
Format: HEX
Address: 0242H
P2-33▲ AUT3 Semi-auto Inertia Adjustment
0243H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 1
Format: DEC
Settings:
Semi-auto setting
Reserved
Not in use
Semi-auto Setting:
1: It means the inertia estimation in semi-auto mode is completed.
The inertia value can be accessed via P1-37.
0: 1. When the display is 0, it means the inertia adjustment is not
completed and is adjusting.
2. When the setting is 0, it means the inertia adjustment is not
completed and is adjusting.
Address: 0244H
P2-34 SDEV The Condition of Overspeed Warning
0245H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 5000
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: r/min
Range: 1 ~ 5000
Format: DEC
Settings: The setting of over speed warning in servo drive error display (P0-01)
Default: 3840000
Control
PT/PR
Mode:
Unit: pulse
Range: 1 ~ 128000000
Format: DEC
Address: 0248H
P2-36 EDI9 Extended EDI9 Functional Planning
0249H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings:
Not in use
Address: 024AH
P2-37 EDI10 Extended EDI10 Functional Planning
024BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 024CH
P2-38 EDI11 Extended EDI11 Functional Planning
024DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 024EH
P2-39 EDI12 Extended EDI12 Functional Planning
024FH
Operational Related Section
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table: 8.1
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0250H
P2-40 EDI13 Extended EDI13 Functional Planning
0251H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0252H
P2-41 EDI14 Extended EDI14 Functional Planning
0253H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Table 8.1
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
P2-42 Reserved
Address: 0256H
P2-43 NCF2 Resonance Suppression (Notch filter) (2)
0257H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.7
Default: 1000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Hz
Range: 50 ~ 2000
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: dB
Format: DEC
Address: 025AH
P2-45 NCF3 Resonance Suppression (Notch filter) (3)
025BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.7
Default: 1000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Hz
Range: 50 ~ 2000
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: dB
Range: 0 ~ 32
Format: DEC
Address: 025EH
P2-47 ANCF Auto Resonance Suppression Mode Setting
025FH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 2
Format: DEC
Settings: 0: The value of P2-43, P2-44 and P2-45, P2-46 will retain.
1: The value of P2-43, P2-44 and P2-45, P2-46 will retain after
resonance suppression.
2: Continuous resonance suppression
Description of Auto Mode Setting:
When it is set to 1: Auto resonance, the value returns to 0
automatically and saves the point of resonance
suppression when it is stable. If it is unstable, re-
power on or set back to 1 for re-estimation again.
When it is set to 2: Continuous suppression automatically. When it is
stable, the point of resonance suppression will be
saved. If it is unstable, re-power on for re-
estimation.
When switching to mode 0 from mode 2 or 1, the setting of P2-43, P2-
44, P2-45 and P2-46 will be saved automatically.
Address: 0260H
P2-48 ANCL Resonance Suppression Detection Level
0261H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 1 ~ 300%
Format: DEC
Settings: (The smaller the setting value is, the more sensitive the resonance will
be.)
P2-48↑, resonance sensitiveness↓
P2-48↓, resonance sensitiveness↑
Address: 0262H
P2-49 SJIT Speed Detection Filter
0263H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0264H
P2-50 DCLR Pulse Clear Mode
0265H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PT
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
P2-51 Reserved
Address: 0268H
P2-52▲ IDXS Indexing Coordinates Scale
0269H
Operational Related Section:
Panel/Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1000000000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: PUU
Range: 0 ~ 1000000000
Format: Decimal
Address: 026AH
P2-53 KPI Position Integral Compensation
026BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 6.3.6
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: rad/s
Range: 0 ~ 1023
Format: DEC
Settings: When increasing the value of position control integral, reducing the
position steady-state error, it may easily cause position overshoot and
noise if the value is set too big.
Address: 026CH
P2-54 SVP The Gain of Synchronous Speed Control
026DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Rad/s
Range: 0~8191
Data Size: 16bit
Format: DEC
Settings: When increasing the value of synchronous speed control, it can
enhance the speed following of two motors. However, if the value is set
too big, it may easily cause vibration and noise.
Address: 0272H
P2-57 SBW The Bandwidth of Synchronous Control
0273H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Hz
Range: 0~1023
Data Size: 16bit
Format: DEC
Settings: If users do not know how to set P2-54~P2-56, setting the bandwidth of
synchronous control value will do since the value will correspond to P2-
54~P2-56. The bigger the bandwidth of synchronous control value is,
the better the synchronous effect will be. When increasing the
bandwidth of speed loop and synchronous control, pay special
attention to the response of P2-25 which should be faster than the
setting of the both bandwidth.
Address: 0274H
P2-58 SVL Low-pass Filter of Synchronous Speed Error
0275H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
U
Unit: 0.1ms
Ran
nge: 0~10
000
Data Size:
S 16bit
Form
mat: DEC
Exam
mple: 15 = 1.5 ms
Settin
ngs: If the
e synchrono ous control is influence
ed by low rresolution and
a causess
noisee (not a high
h-pitched but rough soound), low-ppass filter can be used
d
to soolve this pro
oblem. Pleaase note thaat bandwidtth of the sy ynchronouss
contrrol should bbe set as la
arge as pos ssible and sshould larger than the
e
bandwidth of spe eed-loop.
P2-59 Reserve
ed
Ad
ddress: 0278H
P2-60 GR4 Gear Ra
atio (Numerrator) (N2)
02
279H
Opera
ational Reelated Section: -
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
Interfa
ace:
ault: 128
Defa
Control
C
PT
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: pulse
e
229-1)
nge: 1 ~ (2
Ran
Data Size:
S 32bitt
mat: DEC
Form
Settings: The numerator of electronic gear ratio o can be seelected via DI.GNUM00
and DI.GNUM1 1 (Please refer to table 8.1)). If DI.GN NUM0 andd
DI.GNUM1 are not set, P1-44 will automaticallyy be the numerator of o
electtronic gear rratio. Pleas
se switch GNUM0 and GNUM1 in stop statuss
to av
void the mecchanical vib bration.
Address: 027AH
P2-61 GR5 Gear Ratio (Numerator) (N3)
027BH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 128
Control
PT
Mode:
Unit: pulse
29
Range: 1 ~ (2 -1)
Format: DEC
Address: 027CH
P2-62 GR6 Gear Ratio (Numerator) (N4)
027DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 128
Control
PT
Mode:
Unit: pulse
29
Range: 1 ~ (2 -1)
Format: DEC
P2-63 ~
Reserved
P2-64
Ad
ddress: 028
82H
P2-65 GBIT Special--bit Registe
er
02
283H
Operaational Reelated Section: -
el / Software
Pane e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0
Defa
Control
PT/PR/S
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: 0 ~ 0xFFFF
Ran 0
Data Size:
S -
mat: -
Form
ngs:
Settin
Bit7
7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-119
9
Chapter 8 P
Parameters ASDA-A2
2
Ad
ddress: 028
84H
P2-66 GBIT2
2 Special--bit Registe
er 2
02
285H
Operaational Reelated Section: -
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0
Defa
Control
PT / PR / S
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
nge: 0 ~ 0x000F
Ran 0
Data Size:
S 16bitt
Format: HEX
Address: 0286H
P2-67 JSL The Stable Level of Inertia Estimation
0287H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1.5 15
Control
ALL
Mode:
Settings: In semi-auto mode, if the value of inertia estimation is smaller than P2-
67 and the status remains for a while, the system will regard the inertia
estimation as completed.
Address: 0288H
P2-68 TEP Switch of Following Error Compensation
0289H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 028AH
P2-69● ABS Absolute Encoder Setting
028BH
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Settings: Format: U Z Y X
X: Setup the operation mode
0: Incremental mode. Servo motor with absolute encoder can be
8-122 Revision December 2014
ASDA-A2 Chapter 8 Parameters
Address: 028CH
P2-70 MRS Read Data Format Selection
028DH
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Settings:
Bit7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0
Address: 028EH
P2-71■ CAP Absolute Position Homing
028FH
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Settings: When P2-71 is set to 1, the current position will be set as home position.
This function is the same as the digital input, ABSC. This function can
be enabled only when parameter P2-08 is set to 271.
P2-72 Reserved
Address: 0292H
P2-73 ALOP E-Cam Alignment - Operation Setting
0293H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
and the system will average the errors before correction to avoid
noise. If the error is bigger than filter threshold, the system will use
the new position to do the correction.
YX 00 01 ~ 05F
Function Disabled | Error | <= (1~YX) % : Enabled
*Using filter will allow the alignment action to be more stable and
reduce position error caused by digital input noise.
UZ: Max. Max. allowable correction rate (%)
When alignment correction is enabled, the limitation of max.
correction rate (C) for each correction is defined as follows:
| C | <= (P5-84/P5-83) x P2-73 UZ %
*When the alignment error is too big, to correct this error with one time
may cause the motor vibration or overloading. Using this parameter
will break the alignment correction into several smaller actions to
smooth the correction action. But it may need more time to finish the
alignment correction.
BA: PR number
After each alignment action is done, the shortage of pulse
numbers of slave axis will be stored in this specified PR. Using
this PR can compensate the slave position at appropriate timing.
*If BA is set to 0, it will not store the shortage of pulse numbers to
PR.
DC: Masking range setting (%)
When digital input, ALGN is triggered, no another alignment action
is allowed before the increasing pulse numbers of master axis
exceeds the masking distance (M). After the increasing pulse
numbers of master axis is greater than the distance (M) masking,
the next alignment action is allowed.
The masking distance (M) is defined as follows:
M >= (P5-84/P5-83) x P2-73 DC %
*This masking function only allows increasing pulse input. This function
will not work for decreasing pulse input.
Default: 0.000
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: Decimal
Settings: (This function is available in firmware version V1.038 sub26 and later
models)
This parameter is used to set for the compensation of delay time from
digital input.
Address: 0296H
P2-75■ ALTG E-Cam Alignment - Alignment Target Position
0297H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: Decimal
Settings: (This function is available in firmware version V1.038 sub26 and later
models)
Note: When the input value is over the setting range, an error will occur.
Then, the user cannot input the setting value.
Note: When a correct value is already set in P2-75 and does not
exceed the setting range, if a change on P5-84 or P5-83 cause
the value to exceed the setting range, this parameter will be reset
to 0 automatically.
New value of P2-75 = 0 if P2-75 >=(P5-84 /P5-83)
Address: 0298H
P2-76■ ALCT E-Cam Alignment - Source Setting
0299H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Y: Filter intensity
Y 0 1~F
Function Disabled Average of 2^Z: Enabled
When the value of Y is increased, the change of correction is getting
slow and it can expedite the performance of the filter function. This can
avoid the disturbance caused by a sensor noise and a big error to be
corrected within one time. Setting P2-76 too big will cause the
alignment not able to work properly. The recommendatory value is 3.
UZ: Alignment path definition. Forward direction as setting reference
here (0 ~ 100%)
0: Backward alignment only
30: Forward 30%, Backward 70%
50: Alignment with the shortest distance
80: Forward 80%, Backward 20%
>=100: Forward alignment only
Address: 029AH
P2-77■ CMSK E-Cam Master Axis – Pulse Masking Setting
029BH
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0000h
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Default: 270
Control
PR
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 360
Format: Decimal
Default: 360
Control
PR
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 360
Format: Decimal
Address: 02A0H
P2-80 Z Phase Source of Homing
02A1H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Setting:
Address: 0300H
P3-00● ADR Address Setting
0301H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0x7F
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0302H
P3-01 BRT Transmission Speed
0303H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0x0203
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: bps
Format: HEX
NOTE 1)If this parameter is set via CAN, only Z can be set and the others
remain.
2)The communication speed of USB is 1.0 Mbit/s only and is
unchangeable.
Address: 0304H
P3-02 PTL Communication Protocol
0305H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 6
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x8
Format: HEX
5: 8, O, 1 (MODBUS, ASCII)
6: 8, N, 2 (MODBUS, RTU)
7: 8, E, 1 (MODBUS, RTU)
8: 8, O, 1 (MODBUS, RTU)
Address: 0306H
P3-03 FLT Communication Error Disposal
0307H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x1
Format: HEX
Address: 0308H
P3-04 CWD Communication Timeout
0309H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: sec
Range: 0 ~ 20
Format: DEC
Address: 030AH
P3-05 CMM Communication Mechanism
030BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: Communication port can select one or more than one communications.
Communication Interface
0: RS232
1: RS485
Address: 030CH
P3-06■ SDI Control Switch of Digital Input (DI)
030DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 030EH
P3-07 CDT Communication Response Delay Time
030FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: 1ms
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Address: 0310H
P3-08■ MNS Monitor Mode
0311H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0000
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Low-speed
Function - - Monitor Mode
monitoring time
Range 0 0 0~F 0~3
Address: 0312H
P3-09 SYC CANopen Synchronize Setting
0313H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0314H
P3-10 CANEN CANopen Protocol Setting
0315H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Section 9.2
Default: 0x0000
Control
CANopen
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0316H
P3-11 CANOP CANopen Selection
0317H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Section 9.2
Default: 0x0000
Control
CANopen
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0318H
P3-12 QSTPO CANopen Support Setting
0319H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Section 9.2
Default: 0x0000
Control
CANopen
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0400H
P4-00★ ASH1 Fault Record (N)
0401H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.4.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0402H
P4-01★ ASH2 Fault Record (N-1)
0403H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.4.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0404H
P4-02★ ASH3 Fault Record (N-2)
0405H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.4.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0406H
P4-03★ ASH4 Fault Record (N-3)
0407H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.4.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0408H
P4-04★ ASH5 Fault Record (N-4)
0409H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.4.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: -
Format: HEX
Address: 040AH
P4-05 JOG Servo Motor Jog Control
040BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.4.2
Default: 20
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: r/min
Range: 0 ~ 5000
Format: DEC
NOTE When writing via communication, if the frequency is high, please set
P2-30 to 5.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0xFF
Format: HEX
Address: 040EH
P4-07■ ITST Multi-function of Digital Input
040FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: Section 4.4.4
Table 9.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x3FFF
Format: HEX
Settings: The DI input signal can come from external terminal (DI1 ~ DI8; EDI9 ~
EDI14) or software SDI1 ~ 14 (Bit 0 ~ 13 of corresponding parameter
P4-07) and is determined by P3-06. The corresponding bit of P3-06 is
1, which means the source is software SDI (P4-07). If the
corresponding bit is 0, then the source is hardware DI. See the
following graph:
Address: 0410H
P4-08★ PKEY Input Status of the Drive Keypad (Read-only)
0411H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: (read-only)
Format: HEX
Settings: The aim is to check if the five Keys, MODE, UP, DOWN, SHIFT and
SET can work normally. This parameter is also used to check if the
Keys are all functional when producing servo drives.
Address: 0412H
P4-09★ MOT Digital Output Status (Read-only)
0413H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 4.4.5
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x1F
Format: HEX
Address: 0414H
P4-10■ CEN Adjustment Selection
0415H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 6
Format: DEC
Settings: 0: reserved
1: Execute the adjustment of analog speed input offset
2: Execute the adjustment of analog torque input offset
3: Execute the adjustment of current detector (V phase) hardware
offset
4: Execute the adjustment of current detector (W phase) hardware
offset
5: Execute the adjustment of 1~4 hardware offset
6: Execute the adjustment of IGBT ADC
Address: 0416H
P4-11 SOF1 Analog Speed Input Offset Adjustment 1
0417H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Address: 0418H
P4-12 SOF2 Analog Speed Input Offset Adjustment 2
0419H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Address: 041AH
P4-13 TOF1 Analog Torque Input Offset Adjustment 1
041BH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Address: 041CH
P4-14 TOF2 Analog Torque Input Offset Adjustment 2
041DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: Manually adjust the hardware offset. The adjustment function needs to
be enabled by the setting of parameter P2-08. It is not suggested to
adjust the auxiliary adjustment. This parameter cannot be reset.
Unit: -
Range: 1 ~ 4
Format: DEC
Settings: Please cool down the drive to 25 Celsius degree when adjusting
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: mV
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: mV
Format: DEC
Address: 042CH
P4-22 SAO Analog Speed Input OFFSET
042DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
S
Mode:
Unit: mV
Format: DEC
Address: 042EH
P4-23 TAO Analog Torque Input OFFSET
042FH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
T
Mode:
Unit: mV
Format: DEC
220V Series
Address: 0430H
P4-24 LVL Level of Under voltage Error
0431H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 160
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: V (rms)
Range: 140~190
Format: DEC
Settings: When the voltage of DC BUS is lower than P4-24* 2 , the under
voltage alarm occurs.
400V Series
Address: 0430H
P4-24 LVL Level of Under voltage Error
0431H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 320
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: V (rms)
Range: 140~380
Format: DEC
Settings: When the voltage of DC BUS is lower than P4-24* 2 , the under
voltage alarm occurs.
P5-00 ~
Reserved
P5-02
Address: 0506H
P5-03 PDEC Deceleration Time of Auto Protection
0507H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0XEEEFEEFF
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0508H
P5-04 HMOV Homing Mode
0509H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x128
Format: HEX
Settings:
X: Homing method
Y: Z pulse setting
Z: Limit setting
W: Reserved
Not in use
W Z Y X
Reserved Limit Setting Z pulse Setting Homing Method
- 0~1 0~2 0~8
When Y = 0: Stop and X = 7: Homing in reverse
encounter limit: return to Z direction
Z = 0: shows pulse ORGP: ON OFF, as the
error Y = 1: Go forward homing origin
Z = 1: rotates to Z pulse
X = 8: directly define the
backwards Y = 2: Do not look current position as the origin
for Z pulse
Address: 050AH
P5-05 HSPD1 1st Speed Setting of High Speed Homing
050BH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Format: DEC
Address: 050CH
P5-06 HSPD2 2nd Speed Setting of Low Speed Homing
050DH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Format: DEC
Address: 050EH
P5-07■ PRCM Trigger Position Command (PR mode only)
050FH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 1000
Format: DEC
Address: 0510H
P5-08 SWLP Forward Software Limit
0511H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 2147483647
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: PUU
Format: DEC
Settings: In PR mode, if the motor rotates in forward direction and its command
position exceeds the setting value of P5-08, it will trigger AL.283.
Address: 0512H
P5-09 SWLN Reverse Software Limit
0513H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: -2147483648
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: PUU
Format: DEC
Settings: In PR mode, if the motor rotates in reverse direction and its command
position exceeds the setting value of P5-09, it will trigger AL.285.
Address: 0514H
P5-10★ AYSZ Data Array-Data Size
0515H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.2
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: Read-only
Format: DEC
Address: 0516H
P5-11■ AYID Data Array - Address of Reading / Writing
0517H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The address of specified data when reading or writing data array.
Address: 0518H
P5-12■ AYD0 Data Array-Window #1 for Reading / Writing
0519H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 051AH
P5-13■ AYD1 Data Array - Window #2 for Reading / Writing
051BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
P5-14 Reserved
Address: 051EH
P5-15■ PMEM PATH#1 ~ PATH#2 No Data Retained Setting
051FH
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0520H
P5-16■ AXEN Axis Position - Motor Encoder
0521H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.3
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: DEC
Settings: Read: The feedback position of the motor encoder, which is the
monitor various V000 + the offset value. (This function is supported
after firmware version V1.015)
Write: Any value can be written into the parameter and will neither
change V000 nor influence the positioning coordinate system. It is only
for observation when adjusting the offset value.
Address: 0522H
P5-17 AXAU Axis Position - Auxiliary Encoder
0523H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.3
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: DEC
Settings: Sends back: pulse counts of the auxiliary encoder (linear scale)
Address: 0524H
P5-18 AXPC Axis Position - Pulse Command
0525H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.3
Default: -
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: DEC
Address: 0526H
P5-19 TBS E-Cam Curve Scaling
0527H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 1.000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: DEC
NOTE This parameter can be set anytime, but will be effective only when pre-
engaged → engaged.
Address: 0528H
P5-20 AC0 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #0)
0529H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 200
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 052AH
P5-21 AC1 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #1)
052BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 300
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 052CH
P5-22 AC2 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #2)
052DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 052EH
P5-23 AC3 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #3)
052FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 600
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0530H
P5-24 AC4 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #4)
0531H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 800
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0532H
P5-25 AC5 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #5)
0533H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 900
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0534H
P5-26 AC6 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #6)
0535H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 1000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0536H
P5-27 AC7 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #7)
0537H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 1200
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0538H
P5-28 AC8 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #8)
0539H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 1500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 053AH
P5-29 AC9 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #9)
053BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 2000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 053CH
P5-30 AC10 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #10)
053DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 2500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 053EH
P5-31 AC11 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #11)
053FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 3000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0540H
P5-32 AC12 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #12)
0541H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 5000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0542H
P5-33 AC13 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #13)
0543H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 8000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 65500
Format: DEC
Address: 0544H
P5-34 AC14 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #14)
0545H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 50
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~ 1500
Format: DEC
Settings: The default value of this parameter is smaller (short deceleration time)
and it is used for deceleration time setting of auto protection.
Address: 0546H
P5-35 AC15 Acceleration/Deceleration Time (Number #15)
0547H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 30
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 1 ~1200
Format: DEC
Settings: The default value of this parameter is smaller (short deceleration time)
and it is used for short deceleration time and stops promptly of auto
protection.
Address: 0548H
P5-36 CAST CAPTURE - Start Address of Data Array
0549H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The first data CAPTURE obtained should be saved in the address of
data array.
Address: 054AH
P5-37■ CAAX CAPTURE-Axis Position CNT
054BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11.1
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
NOTE 1)It is writable only when COMPARE stops (please refer to P5-39)
2)If the source is the main encoder, this parameter is write-protected
and the content is the feedback position of the motor (monitoring
variable 00h).
Address: 054CH
P5-38■ CANO CAPTURE-The Number of Capturing Times
054DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11.1
Default: 1
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: When CAP stops, it means the number of data that expect to capture
(readable and writable)
When CAP activates, it means the number of data that has not been
captured (read-only); Every time, when it captures one data, the value
of P5-38 will minus one. When the value is 0, it means the capturing is
completed.
Address: 054EH
P5-39■ CACT CAPTURE-Activate CAP Control
054FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11.1
Default: 0x2010
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings:
X
Y
Z
U
Low word
2-PULSE Cmd
bit 0: When the value set by P5-38 is bigger than 0, set bit 0 to 1 will
activate CAP function and DO.CAP_OK is OFF. Every time,
when a data is captured, the value of P5-38 will minus one. When
the P5-38 is 0, it means the capture function is completed,
DO.CAP_OK is ON and bit 0 will be reset to 0 automatically. If
P5-38 equals to 0, set bit 0 to 1 will not activate CAP function.
DO.CAP_OK is OFF and bit 0 will automatically be set to 0. If
CAP function is activated, it cannot set 1 to bit 0. It only can be
written 0 to disable CAP function.
bit 1: If this bit is 1, when capturing the first data, the current position of
CAP axis will be set to the value of P5-76.
bit 2: If this bit is 1, when capturing the first data, CMP will be activated.
(When bit 0 of P5-59 is set to 1 and P5-58 is set to the previous
value.) If CMP has been activated, then this function is invalid.
bit 3: If this bit is 1, as soon as the CAP finished, PR procedure #50 will
be triggered automatically.
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
st
Settings: The 1 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 100
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
nd
Settings: The 2 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 200
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
rd
Settings: The 3 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 400
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 4 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 5 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 800
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 6 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 1000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 7 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 1500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 8 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 2000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 9 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 2500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The10 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 3000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 11 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 3500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 12 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 4000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 13 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 4500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 14 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 5000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 15 Delay Time of PR mode
Default: 5500
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: ms
Range: 0 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
th
Settings: The 16 Delay Time of PR mode
Address: 0570H
P5-56 CMST COMPARE-Start Address of Data Array
0571H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The first COMPARE data is saved in the address of data array.
Address: 0572H
P5-57■ CMAX COMPARE-Axis Position
0573H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0574H
P5-58■ CMNO COMPARE-Compare Amount
0575H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11.2
Default: 1
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
mat: DEC
Form
Ad
ddress: 057
76H
P5-59 CMCT
T COMPARE-Activa
ate CMP Control
05
577H
Operaational Reelated Section:
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace: 7.111.2
ault: 0064
Defa 40010h
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: -
Data Size:
S 32bit
mat: HEX
Form
ngs:
Settin
X: Se
ee the follow
wing table.
Y: 0-When sel ecting CAP
PTURE AXE
ES, the souurce of CAP
P cannot be
e
d.
changed
1-AUX ENC
C (linear sca
ale) is set as
s the sourcee
2-PULSE C
Cmd
3-Main ENC
C (main enc
coder)
U function - - - Trigger PR
Descriptio - - - When this bit is set to
n 1, PR#45 will be
triggered after the
last compare is
completed.
It is provided in
V1.038 sub09 (or the
later version)
CBA: Output the pulse length; Unit: 1ms
bit 3 2 1 0
bit 0: When the value of P5-58 is more than 0, set bit to 1 will activate
CMP. When comparing one data, the value of P5-58 will minus 1.
When P5-58 is set to 0, the comparing is completed and returns
to 0. If P5-58 is 0, set bit 0 to 1 will not do any comparing and
return to 0 automatically. If bit 0 has already been set to 1, it is not
allowed to write 1 as the new value into the parameter. But it is ok
to write 0 to disable CMP.
bit 1: If this bit is 1, P5-58 will be reset after comparing the last data.
Then, start from the first data again. The cycle will never end and
bit 0 is always 1.
bit 2: If this bit is 1, CAP will be activated after comparing the last data.
(Set bit 0 of P5-39 to 1 and reset P5-38 to the previous value) If
CAP has already been activated, this function is invalid.
bit 3: If this bit is 1, set the counter (P5-57) to 0 after comparing the last
data. For example, if the comparing data is set to 3000 (one data
in total), the default value of the counter (P5-57) is 0. It is
expected to input 4000 pulse. When it reaches the 3000th pulse,
the CMP is completed and P5-57 returns to 0. When the pulse
reaches 4000, P5-57=1000. (No accumulative error)
Address: 0578H
P5-60 POV0 Target Speed Setting #0
0579H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 057AH
P5-61 POV1 Target Speed Setting #1
057BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 057CH
P5-62 POV2 Target Speed Setting #2
057DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: DEC
Address: 057EH
P5-63 POV3 Target Speed Setting #3
057FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0580H
P5-64 POV4 Target Speed Setting #4
0581H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0582H
P5-65 POV5 Target Speed Setting #5
0583H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0584H
P5-66 POV6 Target Speed Setting #6
0585H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0586H
P5-67 POV7 Target Speed Setting #7
0587H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0588H
P5-68 POV8 Target Speed Setting #8
0589H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 058AH
P5-69 POV9 Target Speed Setting #9
058BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: DEC
Address: 058CH
P5-70 POV10 Target Speed Setting #10
058DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 058EH
P5-71 POV11 Target Speed Setting #11
058FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0590H
P5-72 POV12 Target Speed Setting #12
0591H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0592H
P5-73 POV13 Target Speed Setting #13
0593H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0594H
P5-74 POV14 Target Speed Setting #14
0595H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0596H
P5-75 POV15 Target Speed Setting #15
0597H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Format: DEC
Address: 0598H
P5-76★ CPRS CAPTURE-First Position Reset Data
0599H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: The position of this axis will synchronize with CAP signal. That is to
say, when activating CAP every two times, the motor moving distance
of this axis is the value of P5-78. (There is no accumulative error and
only in single-way operation) The synchronous capture axis can be the
source of Master.
Default: 100
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: Pulse
Range: 10 ~ +100000000
Format: DEC
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: DEC
Default: 10
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: %
Range: 0 ~ 90
Format: DEC
Address: 05A2H
P5-81 ECHD E-CAM: Start Address of Data Array
05A3H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 100
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ (800-P5-82)
Format: DEC
Settings: The first data of E-Cam table is saved in the address of data array.
Address: 05A4H
P5-82 ECMN E-CAM: Area Number N (at least >=5)
05A5H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 5
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: It means the E-Cam curve is divided into N area, and the table should
include N+1 data.
NOTE 1. This parameter can be wrote when E-Cam stops (Please refer
toP5-88, X=0).
2. A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Address: 05A6H
P5-83 ECMM E-CAM: Master Gear Ratio Setting M
05A7H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 1
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 1 ~ 32767
Format: DEC
Settings: When receiving pulse number P of the Master, E-Cam will rotate M
circle, which means the M cycle of the E-Cam table.
NOTE 1. This parameter can be wrote when E-Cam stops (Please refer
toP5-88, X=0).
2. A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Address: 05A8H
P5-84 ECMP E-CAM: Master Gear Ratio Setting P
05A9H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 3600
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 10 ~ 1073741823,
and P5-82 x P5-83 <= P5-84
Format: DEC
Settings: When receiving pulse number P of the Master, E-Cam will rotate M
circle, which means the M cycle of the E-Cam table.
NOTE 1. This parameter can be wrote when E-Cam stops (Please refer
toP5-88, X=0).
2. This parameter can be modified anytime, and has no limit that
mentioned above.
3. A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Address: 05AAH
P5-85 ECME E-CAM: Number of Area
05ABH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ (P5-82-1)
Format: DEC
Address: 05ACH
P5-86■ ECAX E-CAM: Master Axis Position
05ADH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
NOTE 1. This parameter can be wrote when E-Cam stops (Please refer
toP5-88, X=0).
2. A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Address: 05AEH
P5-87 PLED E-CAM: Lead Pulse
05AFH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: When the engaging condition (P5-88.Z) of E-cam is satisfied, the pulse
number from the master has to exceed the setting value of this
parameter, so that E-cam is fully engaged.
In other words, E-cam engages after neglecting the lead pulse
specified by this parameter.
If the symbol of this parameter is +, it means the received forward pulse
is regarded as the lead pulse.
If the symbol of this parameter is - , it means the received reverse
pulse is regarded as the lead pulse.
NOTE A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Address: 05B0H
P5-88■ ECON E-CAM: Activate E-Cam Control
05B1H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 00000000h
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x203FF257
Data
32bit
Size:
Format: HEX
Settings: The format of this parameter: (High word h) S0BA:(Low word L) UZYX
Definition of each column is as follows:
X: E-Cam command
Description of each bit:
X3 - -
X2 P5-19 is It is available after V1.038 sub48:
effective 0: P5-19 is effective after the next engage.
immediately
1: P5-19is effective immediately.
X1 E-Cam does It is available after 1.038 sub29:
not 0: E-Cam does not work
disengage
1: When E-Cam stops because of alarm or
when Servo
Servo Off, it can keep in engaged status.
OFF
When re-servo on, E-cam can operate
directly. It can return to the correct position
by macro #D.
X0 E-Cam is 0: E-Cam is disabled
enabled 1: E-Cam is enabled (E-CAM is enabled while
other functions cannot be modified.)
Y: Command source
0: CAP axis
1: AUX ENC
2: Pulse Cmd
3: PR command
4: Time Axis (1ms)
5: Synchronous Capture Axis (P5-77)
6: Analog channel 1 (virtual axis, Unit: 1M pulse/s /10V)
Address: 05B2H
P5-89 ECRD E-CAM: Information of Disengaging Time
05B3H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 05B4H
P5-90 CMAP E-CAM: AREA No.+The Point of DO ON
05B5H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Range: 0 ~ 360
Format: DEC
Settings: When E-cam is engaged, set the start angle of DO output (DO.
CAM_AREA).
NOTE A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Address: 05B6H
P5-91 CMAN E-CAM: AREA No. - The Point of DO OFF
05B7H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: Degree
Range: 0 ~ 360
Format: DEC
Settings: When E-cam is engaged, set the end angle of DO output (DO.
CAM_AREA).
Address: 05B8H
P5-92 PLED E-CAM: Pre-engaged Time of Each Cycle
05B9H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.11
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: This parameter goes with the selection of P5-88, U=4 (E-cam will
disengage if it exceeds the moving distance):
After disengaging, it does not enter the Stop status but pre-engaged
status. The lead pulse is determined by this parameter.
The pulse number sent by the Master must exceed the setting value of
this parameter so that E-cam will engage again.
In other words, E-cam will engage not until the lead pulse is ignored.
If the symbol of this parameter is +, it means the received positive
pulse will be regarded as the lead pulse.
If the symbol of this parameter is -, it means the received negative
pulse will be regarded as the lead pulse.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: Before issuing the macro command, the relevant parameters # 4 must
be set in advance.
The function of the parameter is determined by the macro command.
Not every macro command has its relevant parameters.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: Before issuing the macro command, the relevant parameters # 3 must
be set in advance.
The function of the parameter is determined by the macro command.
Not every macro command has its relevant parameters.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: Before issuing the macro command, the relevant parameters # 2 must
be set in advance.
The function of the parameter is determined by the macro command.
Not every macro command has its relevant parameters.
Motion Control Macro Command: Command Address: 05C0H
P5-96 CSDS
Parameter # 1 05C1H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Settings: Before issuing the macro command, the relevant parameters # 1 must
be set in advance.
The function of the parameter is determined by the macro command.
Not every macro command has its relevant parameters.
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x99F
Format: Hex
This macro will calculate the data of E-Cam table according to the above
mentioned parameters, and store in data array which designated by P5-
81.Parameters listed above are related to E-Cam table calculation. Please correctly
setup those parameters before executing this macro.
After this macro is executed, if the above parameters have been changed, it has to
recreate the E-Cam table and this macro will have to be executed again. Data in E-
Cam table will be changed after executing this macro; thus, do not execute it when
E-Cam is in engaged status.
In E-Cam application, parameters, such as P5-83 and P5-84 that are not related to
this macro are not listed here. Users could setup parameters according to the real
application. Please refer to Chapter 7, sections about E-Cam.
After executing this macro, E-Cam table will not be saved to EEPROM
automatically.
Failure code F061h When creating the table, E-Cam is in engaged status.
Failure code F062h The setting value of P5-94 exceeds the range: (1 ~ 65535)
Failure code F063h The setting value of P5-95 exceeds the range: (1 ~ 65535)
Failure code F064h The setting value of P5-96 exceeds the range: (300000 ~
2500000)
Failure code F065h The address specified by P5-81is too long and the space of
data array is not enough.
Failure code F066h The setting value of P5-82 should be set to 7. Otherwise the
command cannot be executed.
Failure code F067h Data calculation error. Please decrease the setting value of
(P1-44, P1-45) and keep the proportion will do.
After this macro is executed, if the above parameters have been changed, it has to
recreate the E-Cam table and this macro will have to be executed again. Data in E-
Cam table will be changed after executing this macro; thus, do not execute it when
E-Cam is in engaged status.
In E-Cam application, parameters, such as P5-83 and P5-84 that are not related to
this macro are not listed here. Users could setup parameters according to the real
application. Please refer to Chapter 7, sections about
After executing this macro, E-Cam table will not be saved to EEPROM
automatically.
Failure code F071h When creating the table, E-Cam is in engaged status.
Failure code F072h P5-94 degree of synchronous area exceeds the range: (0 ~
330)
Failure code F073h P5-93.H16 curve level exceeds the range: (1 ~ 4)
Failure code F074h P5-93.L16 degree of waiting area exceeds the range: (0 ~
170)
Failure code F075h The setting value of P5-96 exceeds the range: (50000 ~
5000000)
Failure code F076h P5-82 area number of E-Cam exceeds the range: (30 ~ 72)
Failure code F077h The address specified by P5-81is too long and the space of
data array is not enough.
Failure code F078h Data calculation error. Please decrease the setting value of
(P1-44, P1-45) and keep the proportion will do.
Failure code F079h Acceleration degree is too small, and then please decreases
the value of waiting area (W), synchronous area (Y) or curve
level (S).
Failure code Waiting area is too small, then please increase the value of
F07Ah acceleration area (W) or decrease the value of synchronous
area (Y)
The following macros are available from version V1.042 sub09 (included):
Engaged: 1 Stop: 0
5
4 1
3 2
P5-19 is loading into
E-Cam scaling. Lead: 2
In application, two ways can change the setting of E-Cam curve scaling.
1. P5-88.X2 = 1: When E-Cam is engaged, setup this bit at the same time.
Function of P5-19 will be enabled immediately.
2. Use macro#8: Every time when this macro command is triggered, function of
P5-19 will be enabled. However, if the value of P5-19 is changed and this
macro is not triggered, function of P5-19 will not be enabled. This macro
command has to be triggered again.
Failure code N/A
The following macros are available from version V1.035 sub00 (included):
Note: When using this macro command, it would be better to execute this
command before operate the master axis.
Failure code When executing this macro command, E-Cam is not in
F0C1h engaged status.
To modify the engaged position only when E-Cam is
engaged.
Failure code The setting value of P5-93 is in error. The value cannot less
F0C2h than 0. It should > = 0.
Failure code The setting value of P5-93 is in error. The value has to less
F0C3h than the value of (P5-84 / P5-83)
The following macros are available from version V1.038 sub48 (included):
Command code Calculate the error between E-Cam and indexing coordinates
000Dh for PR positioning.
General N/A
Parameters
Macro Parameters P5-93.Low_Word = DCBA: UZYX (8 digits, HEX)
YX (PR number) = 0~0x3F (it is invalid when the value is set
to 0)
UZ: The value has to be set to 0.
BA (Function of P5-95):
0 (Use avoid point),
1 (Use available forward rate, V1.038 sub53)
DC (Inhibit reverse rotation):
0 (invalid),
1(Inhibit reverse rotation, V1.038 sub53)
P5-95: Avoid point (cannot pass this point) = 0 ~ 100 (%) of
E-Cam cycle or available forward rate 0 ~ 100 (%)
Monitoring variable 091(5Bh): It displays the current indexing coordinate position
(PUU)
When E-Cam is engaged, and the motor is stopped because of Servo Off or alarm
occurs, it would cause position error between the actual position and E-Cam
position. After re-servo On, this macro command can be used to calculate the
correction value and write the value into the specified PR for incremental
positioning. So that the motor can return to the ideal E-Cam position.
When using this macro command:
1. P5-88.X1 = 1 to make E-Cam keep engaging when servo off and continue to
calculate E-Cam position.
2. The height of indexing coordinate and E-Cam coordinate should be the same:
P2-52= ECAM_H (The moving distance when E-cam operates one cycle)
3. E-Cam table scaling (P5-19) must be 1.0 time
4. When E-Cam is engaged for the first time, 0 degree of E-cam should aim at 0
degree of indexing coordinate.
5. This macro command only can be applicable on periodic cycle and when every
cycle starts from the same position.
Note 1: ECAM_H (height of E-Cam table) = E-Cam table (last point - first points)
Note 2: Indexing coordinate = (absolute coordinates/P2-52) take remainder.
Note 3: Use PR command for incremental positioning control.
When motor moves from the current position to the target position, it can operate at
forward or reverse direction. Due to the cyclic operation, the motor will travel to the
specified position either at forward or reverse direction. However, the moving
distance is different between both. Uses avoid point to plan the timing of forward
and reverse rotation.
*Avoid point: the point that cannot be passed by the planned PR.
Failure code E-Cam is not engaged when executing this macro command.
F0D1h E-Cam should be engaged.
Failure code The value of P5-93.YX (PR number) exceeds the range: 1 ~
F0D2h 0x3F
Failure code The value of P5-95 (available forward rate) exceeds the
F0D3h range: 0 ~ 100 (%)
Failure code The position correction value does not exist. This macro
The following macros are provided after version V1.038 sub26 (included):
*P5-93.UZ is able to limit the max. correction rate. The alignment target position
★ will be different from P5-96.
a| alignment target position★ – current engaged position| / L <= P5-93.UZ %
*DI time delay compensation can be set via P5-94, it can correct the error caused
by different speed of motion.
When E-Cam moves from current position to the target one, it can rotate at forward
or reverse position. Due to the cyclic operation, it can reach the target position
either at forward or reverse direction. However, the moving distance between both
is usually different. Use available forward rate to plan the timing of forward and
reverse rotation.
*Available forward rate: The available max. proportion of forward path
Failure code When executing this macro, E-Cam is not engaged. E-Cam
F0E1h has to engage to execute alignment correction.
Failure code The setting value of P5-93.YX (PR number) exceeds the
F0E2h range: 0 ~ 0x3F
The following macros are available from version V1.042 sub09 (included):
Command code E-Cam stops for one cycle and resumes its operation at next
0010h cycle.
General N/A
parameters
Macro parameters Value of P5-93 has to be set to 0.
After E-Cam is engaged, this macro command can stop the slave axis for a cycle of
distance regardless the E-Cam degree.
The following conditions have to be established when using this macro command.
1. E-Cam must be in engaged status.
2. E-Cam must be the forward operation curve (including straight line) so it can
stop temporally.
Refer to the figure below, triggering this macro command, E-Cam will stop for one
cycle regardless the degree (X) where E-Cam is.
Note 1: ECAM_H (E-Cam pause distance) = table (last point – first point) x P5-19 (the
effective scaling)
Note 2: This function can accumulate times. If the command is triggered for N times
consecutively, it will stop the E-Cam for N cycles. The accumulated pause distance
cannot exceed (>2^31), or the macro command will be disabled.
Note 3: When E-Cam resumes the operation, the accumulated pause distance will be
cleared to 0.
Failure code F101h When executing this macro command, E-Cam is not
engaged.
Failure code F102h The setting value of P5-93 is incorrect: It has to be set to 0.
Failure code F103h E-Cam has to operate at forward direction. Please check the
E-Cam table and make sure P5-19 > 0.
Failure code F104h The accumulated pause distance exceeds 2^31. Do not
execute this macro command consecutively.
Note: A2L does not support E-Cam function.
Address: 05C4H
P5-98 EVON PR# Triggered by Event Rising-Edge
05C5H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 05C6H
P5-99 EVOF PR# Triggered by Event Falling-Edge
05C7H
Operational Related Section: -
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0600H
P6-00 ODEF Homing Definition
0601H
Operational Related Section;
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0602H
P6-01 ODAT Origin Definition
0603H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0604H
P6-02 PDEF1 PATH#1 Definition
0605H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0606H
P6-03 PDAT1 PATH# 1 Data
0607H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0608H
P6-04 PDEF2 PATH# 2 Definition
0609H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 060AH
P6-05 PDAT2 PATH# 2 Data
060BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 060CH
P6-06 PDEF3 PATH# 3 Definition
060DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 060EH
P6-07 PDAT3 PATH# 3 Data
060FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0610H
P6-08 PDEF4 PATH# 4 Definition
0611H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0612H
P6-09 PDAT4 PATH# 4 Data
0613H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0614H
P6-10 PDEF5 PATH# 5 Definition
0615H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0616H
P6-11 PDAT5 PATH# 5 Data
0617H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0618H
P6-12 PDEF6 PATH# 6 Definition
0619H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 061AH
P6-13 PDAT6 PATH# 6 Data
061BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 061CH
P6-14 PDEF7 PATH# 7 Definition
061DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 061EH
P6-15 PDAT7 PATH# 7 Data
061FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0620H
P6-16 PDEF8 PATH# 8 Definition
0621H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0622H
P6-17 PDAT8 PATH# 8 Data
0623H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0624H
P6-18 PDEF9 PATH# 9 Definition
0625H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0626H
P6-19 PDAT9 PATH# 9 Data
0627H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0628H
P6-20 PDEF10 PATH# 10 Definition
0629H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 062AH
P6-21 PDAT10 PATH# 10 Data
062BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Format: DEC
Address: 062CH
P6-22 PDEF11 PATH# 11 Definition
062DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 062EH
P6-23 PDAT11 PATH# 11 Data
062FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0630H
P6-24 PDEF12 PATH# 12 Definition
0631H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0632H
P6-25 PDAT12 PATH# 12 Data
0633H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0634H
P6-26 PDEF13 PATH# 13 Definition
0635H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0636H
P6-27 PDAT13 PATH# 13 Data
0637H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0638H
P6-28 PDEF14 PATH# 14 Definition
0639H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 063AH
P6-29 PDAT14 PATH# 14 Data
063BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 063CH
P6-30 PDEF15 PATH# 15Definition
063DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 063EH
P6-31 PDAT15 PATH# 15 Data
063FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0640H
P6-32 PDEF16 PATH# 16 Definition
0641H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0642H
P6-33 PDAT16 PATH# 16 Data
0643H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0644H
P6-34 PDEF17 PATH# 17 Definition
0645H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0646H
P6-35 PDAT17 PATH# 17 Data
0647H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0648H
P6-36 PDEF18 PATH# 18 Definition
0649H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 064AH
P6-37 PDAT18 PATH# 18 Data
064BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 064CH
P6-38 PDEF19 PATH# 19 Definition
064DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 064EH
P6-39 PDAT19 PATH# 19 Data
064FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0650H
P6-40 PDEF20 PATH# 20 Definition
0651H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0652H
P6-41 PDAT20 PATH# 20 Data
0653H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0654H
P6-42 PDEF21 PATH# 21 Definition
0655H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0658H
P6-44 PDEF22 PATH# 22 Definition
0659H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 065AH
P6-45 PDAT22 PATH# 22Data
065BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 065CH
P6-46 PDEF23 PATH# 23Definition
065DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 065EH
P6-47 PDAT23 PATH# 23Data
065FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0660H
P6-48 PDEF24 PATH# 24Definition
0661H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0662H
P6-49 PDAT24 PATH# 24Data
0663H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0664H
P6-50 PDEF25 PATH# 25Definition
0665H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0666H
P6-51 PDAT25 PATH# 25Data
0667H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0668H
P6-52 PDEF26 PATH# 26Definition
0669H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 066AH
P6-53 PDAT26 PATH# 26Data
066BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 066CH
P6-54 PDEF27 PATH# 27Definition
066DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 066EH
P6-55 PDAT27 PATH# 27Data
066FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0670H
P6-56 PDEF28 PATH# 28Definition
0671H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0672H
P6-57 PDAT28 PATH# 28Data
0673H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0674H
P6-58 PDEF29 PATH# 29Definition
0675H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0676H
P6-59 PDAT29 PATH# 29Data
0677H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0678H
P6-60 PDEF30 PATH# 30Definition
0679H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 067AH
P6-61 PDAT30 PATH# 30Data
067BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 067CH
P6-62 PDEF31 PATH# 31Definition
067DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 067EH
P6-63 PDAT31 PATH# 31Data
067FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0680H
P6-64 PDEF32 PATH# 32Definition
0681H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0682H
P6-65 PDAT32 PATH# 32Data
0683H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0684H
P6-66 PDEF33 PATH# 33Definition
0685H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0686H
P6-67 PDAT33 PATH# 33Data
0687H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0688H
P6-68 PDEF34 PATH# 34Definition
0689H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 068AH
P6-69 PDAT34 PATH# 34Data
068BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 068CH
P6-70 PDEF35 PATH# 35Definition
068DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 068EH
P6-71 PDAT35 PATH# 35Data
068FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0690H
P6-72 PDEF36 PATH# 36Definition
0691H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0692H
P6-73 PDAT36 PATH# 36Data
0693H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0694H
P6-74 PDEF37 PATH# 37Definition
0695H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0696H
P6-75 PDAT37 PATH# 37Data
0697H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0698H
P6-76 PDEF38 PATH# 38Definition
0699H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 069AH
P6-77 PDAT38 PATH# 38Data
069BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 069CH
P6-78 PDEF39 PATH# 39Definition
069DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 069EH
P6-79 PDAT39 PATH# 39Data
069FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06A0H
P6-80 PDEF40 PATH# 40Definition
06A1H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06A2H
P6-81 PDAT40 PATH# 40Data
06A3H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06A4H
P6-82 PDEF41 PATH# 41Definition
06A5H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06A6H
P6-83 PDAT41 PATH# 41Data
06A7H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06A8H
P6-84 PDEF42 PATH# 42Definition
06A9H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06AAH
P6-85 PDAT42 PATH# 42Data
06ABH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06ACH
P6-86 PDEF43 PATH# 43Definition
06ADH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06AEH
P6-87 PDAT43 PATH# 43Data
06AFH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06B0H
P6-88 PDEF44 PATH# 44Definition
06B1H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06B2H
P6-89 PDAT44 PATH# 44Data
06B3H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06B4H
P6-90 PDEF45 PATH# 45Definition
06B5H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06B6H
P6-91 PDAT45 PATH# 45Data
06B7H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06B8H
P6-92 PDEF46 PATH# 46Definition
06B9H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06BAH
P6-93 PDAT46 PATH# 46Data
06BBH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06BCH
P6-94 PDEF47 PATH# 47Definition
06BDH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06BEH
P6-95 PDAT47 PATH# 47Data
06BFH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06C0H
P6-96 PDEF48 PATH# 48Definition
06C1H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06C2H
P6-97 PDAT48 PATH# 48Data
06C3H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 06C4H
P6-98 PDEF49 PATH# 49Definition
06C5H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 06C6H
P6-99 PDAT49 PATH# 49Data
06C7H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0700H
P7-00 PDEF50 PATH# 50 Definition
0701H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0702H
P7-01 PDAT50 PATH# 50 Data
0703H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0704H
P7-02 PDEF51 PATH# 51 Definition
0705H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0706H
P7-03 PDAT51 PATH# 51 Data
0707H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0708H
P7-04 PDEF52 PATH# 52 Definition
0709H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 070AH
P7-05 PDAT52 PATH# 52 Data
070BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 070CH
P7-06 PDEF53 PATH# 53 Definition
070DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 070EH
P7-07 PDAT53 PATH# 53 Data
070FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0710H
P7-08 PDEF54 PATH# 54 Definition
0711H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0712H
P7-09 PDAT54 PATH# 54 Data
0713H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0714H
P7-10 PDEF55 PATH# 55 Definition
0715H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0716H
P7-11 PDAT55 PATH# 55 Data
0717H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0718H
P7-12 PDEF56 PATH# 56 Definition
0719H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 071AH
P7-13 PDAT56 PATH# 56 Data
071BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 071CH
P7-14 PDEF57 PATH# 57 Definition
071DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 071EH
P7-15 PDAT57 PATH# 57 Data
071FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0720H
P7-16 PDEF58 PATH# 58 Definition
0721H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0722H
P7-17 PDAT58 PATH# 58 Data
0723H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0724H
P7-18 PDEF59 PATH# 59 Definition
0725H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0726H
P7-19 PDAT59 PATH# 59 Data
0727H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0728H
P7-20 PDEF60 PATH# 60 Definition
0729H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 072AH
P7-21 PDAT60 PATH# 60 Data
072BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 072CH
P7-22 PDEF61 PATH# 61 Definition
072DH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 072EH
P7-23 PDAT61 PATH# 61 Data
072FH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0730H
P7-24 PDEF62 PATH# 62 Definition
0731H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0732H
P7-25 PDAT62 PATH# 62 Data
0733H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Address: 0734H
P7-26 PDEF63 PATH# 63 Definition
0735H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0x00000000
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0736H
P7-27 PDAT63 PATH# 63 Data
0737H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.10
Default: 0
Control
PR
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: DEC
Setting value of
P1-38 (Zero speed)
ZCLAMP
input signal
OFF ON
Motor Speed
Setting value of
P1-38 (Zero speed)
Time
Setting Value: When DI.ABSE is ON, DI4 inputs ABSQ signal, function set by P2-13 is
disabled.
Trigger Control
DI Name Function Description of Digital Input (DI)
Method Mode
ABSQ is During I/O transmission, Handshaking signal will be sent to the Rising ALL
always servo drive by the controller. When DI.ABSQ is OFF, it means the and
inputted controller issues Request ; DI.ABSQ is ON means the controller Falling
by DI4 has already recdived ABSD signal. When DI.ABSE is ON, this DI edge
is enabled. Please refer to diagram 12.4 for detailed description. triggered
Setting Va
alue: 0x43, 0x44
Trigger Control
DI Name Function
n Descriptio
on of Digital Input (DI)
Method Mode
GNUM0 Gear Ratio
o Selection 0 (Numerattor) Level PT
GNUM1 Gear Ratio
o Selection 1 (Numerattor) triggeredd
Setting Va
alue: 0x45
Trigger Control
DI Name Function
n Descriptio
on of Digital Input (DI)
Method Mode
INHP In position mode, whe en this DI is ON, the exxternal pulse
e input Level PT
command is not workiing. triggeredd
(Note: Thee function ha
as to be sett to DI8 so as
a to ensure e the
instantaneity of pulse prohibition))
Setting Va
alue: 0x46
Trigger Control
DI Name Function
n Descriptio
on of Digital Input (DI)
Method Mode
STOP Motor stop
ps Rising PR
edge
triggeredd
Setting Va
alue: 0x47
Trigger Control
DI Name Function
n Descriptio n of Digital Input (DI)
Method Mode
PFQS This DI can n be used to
o stop the eemergency stop of deceleration
time. The setting
s eceleration time is iden
of de ntical to P5--03. When Rising
DI.PFQS iss on, AL35F F will occur.. Then, mottor starts to edge PT,PR,T,S
S
decelerate. When the speed reacches 0, AL3 3CF occurs and servo triggered
is off. Please turn on DI.ARST
D to servo on thhe drive aga ain.
N
NOTE 1)11 ~ 17 Single control modes; 18~
~20 Dual con
ntrol mode.
2
2)When P2--10 ~ P2-17 is set to 0, DI
D has no function.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 8-275
5
Chapter 8 Parameters ASDA-A2
MBT1(P1-42) MBT2(P1-43)
Motor ZSPD
Speed (P1-38)
Setting Value: When DI.ABSE is ON, DO2 outputs ABSR signal, function set by P2-19 is
disabled.
Trigger Control
DO Name Function Description of Digital Output (DO)
Method Mode
ABSR is DO.ABSR is OFF means the Request sent by ABSQ has been Level ALL
always received. DO.ABSR is ON means the data that is outputted by triggered
outputted ABSD is valid. When DI.ABSE is ON, this DO is enabled. Please
by DO2 refer to diagram 12.4 for detailed description.
Setting Value: When DI.ABSE is ON, DO3 outputs ABSD signal, function set by P2-20 is
disabled.
Trigger Control
DO Name Function Description of Digital Output (DO)
Method Mode
ABSD is Position data of ABS is outputted. The data is valid when ABSR is Level ALL
always ON. When DI.ABSE is ON, this DO is enabled. Please refer to triggered
outputted diagram 13.4 for detailed description.
by DO3
RS-232
Configuration
NOTE
1) 15-meter communication cable is suitable for less interference environment. If the transmission
speed is over 38400bps, the length of communication cable should be shorter than 3 meters so
as to ensure the accuracy of transmission.
2) Numbers shown in the above diagram represent the pin number of each connector.
RS-485
Configuration
NOTE
1) 100 meters of communication cable is suitable for less interference environment. If the
transmission speed is over 38400bps, the length of communication cable should not longer
than 15 meters so as to ensure the accuracy of transmission.
2) Numbers shown in the above diagram represent the pin number of each connector.
3) Please use the power supply unit whose direct current is over 12 volt.
4) Using RS-485 can connect up to 32 servo drives at the same time. REPEATER can be used
to connect more servo drives. 127 is the maximum.
5) Please refer to Chapter 3.6 for CN3 Pin Definition.
Address: 0300H
P3-00● ADR Address Setting
0301H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0x7F
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Address: 0302H
P3-01 BRT Transmission Speed
0303H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0x0203
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: bps
Format: HEX
NOTE 1)If this parameter is set via CAN, only Z can be set and the others
remain.
2)The communication speed of USB is 1.0 Mbit/s only and is
unchangeable.
Address: 0304H
P3-02 PTL Communication Protocol
0305H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 6
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 0 ~ 0x8
Format: HEX
Address: 030AH
P3-05 CMM Communication Mechanism
030BH
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 9.2
Default: 0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Format: HEX
Settings: Communication port can select one or more than one communications.
Communication Interface
0: RS232
1: RS485
Code Description
ASCII Mode:
The so-called ASCII mode is using American Standard Code for Information Interchange (ASCII) to
transmit the data. Between two stations (Master and Slave) to transmit data 64H, the master will
send‘6’which represented by 36H of ASCII code and ‘4’ represented by 34H of ASCII code.
RTU Mode:
Every 8-bit of data is constituted by two 4-bits hexadecimal characters. If data 64H is transmitted
between two stations, it will be transmitted directly, which is more efficient than ASCII mode.
Character Structure
Characters will be encoded into the following framing and transmitted in serial. The checking
method of different bit is as the following.
7-data bits
10-bits character frame
7E1
Start Even Stop
bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 parity bit
7-data bits
10-bits character frame
7O1
Start Odd Stop
bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 parity bit
7-data bits
10-bits character frame
8E1
Start Even Stop
bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
parity bit
8-data bits
11-bits character frame
8O1
Start Odd Stop
bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
parity bit
8-data bits
11-bits character frame
ASCII Mode:
Start Start character ’: ’ (3AH)
Slave Address Communication address: 1-byte consists of 2 ASCII codes
Function Function code: 1-byte consists of 2 ASCII codes
Data (n-1)
……. Data content: n-word = 2n-byte includes 4n of ASCII code, n<=10
Data (0)
LRC Error checking: 1-byte consists of 2 ASCII codes
End 1 End code 1: (0DH)(CR)
End 0 End code 0: (0AH)(LF)
The start character of communication in ASCII mode is colon ‘:’ (ASCII is 3AH), ADR is the ASCII
code of two characters. The end code is CR (Carriage Return) and LF (Line Feed). And the
communication address, function code, data content, error checking LRC (Longitudinal
Redundancy Check), etc are between the start character and end code.
RTU Mode:
Start A silent interval of more than 10ms
Slave Address Communication address: 1-byte
Function Function code: 1-byte
Data (n-1)
……. Data content:n-word =2n-byte,n<=10
Data (0)
CRC Error checking: 2-byte
End 1 A silent interval of more than 10ms
The start of communication in RTU (Remote Terminal Unit) mode is a silent interval. The end of it
is another silent interval. The communication address, function code, data content, error checking
CRC (Cyclical Redundancy Check), etc are between the start and the end.
The Master issues the command to the 1st Slave and reads the continuous 2 words starting from
the start address 0200H. In response message from the Slave, the content of starting address
0200H is 00B1H and the content of the 2nd data address 0201H is 1F40H. The maximum allowable
data in one single access is 10. The calculation of LRC and CRC will be described in next chapter.
ASCII Mode:
Command message (Master): Response message (Slave):
Start ‘:’ Start ‘:’
‘0’ ‘0’
Slave Address Slave Address
‘1’ ‘1’
‘0’ ‘0’
Function Function
‘3’ ‘3’
‘0’ Number of data ‘0’
RTU Mode:
Command message (Master): Response message (Slave):
Slave Address 01H Slave Address 01H
Function 03H Function 03H
Please note:
Before and after the transmission in RTU mode, 10ms of silent interval is needed.
The Master issues command to the 1st Slave and writes data 0064H to address 0200H. The Slave
sends the response message to the Master after the writing is completed. The calculation of LRC
and CRC will be described in next chapter.
ASCII Mode:
Command message (Master): Response message (Slave):
Start ‘:’ Start ‘:’
‘0’ ‘0’
Slave Address Slave Address
‘1’ ‘1’
‘0’ ‘0’
Function Function
‘6’ ‘6’
‘0’ ‘0’
RTU Mode:
Command message (Master): Response message (Slave):
Address 01H Address 01H
Slave Function 06H Slave Function 06H
Please note:
Before and after the transmission in RTU mode, 10ms of silent interval is needed.
The Master issues command to the 1st Slave and writes 0BB8H and 0000H to the starting address
0112H. That is to say, 0112H is written into 0BB8H and 0113H is written into 0000H. The
maximum allowable data in one single access is 10. The Slave sends the response message to
the Master after the writing is completed. The calculation of LRC and CRC will be described in next
chapter.
ASCII Mode:
Command message (Master): Response message (Slave):
Start ‘:’ Start ‘:’
‘0’ ‘0’
Slave Address Slave Address
‘1’ ‘1’
‘1’ ‘1’
Function Function
‘0’ ‘0’
‘0’ ‘0’
RTU Mode:
Command message (Master): Response message (Slave):
Slave Address 01H Slave Address 01H
Function 10H Function 10H
Please note:
Before and after the transmission in RTU mode, 10ms of silent interval is needed.
The error checking in ASCII communication mode is LRC (Longitudinal Redundancy Check); CRC
(Cyclical Redundancy Check) is for RTU communication mode. The algorithm of both is as the
following.
The LRC algorithm is: add all byte, round down the carry and take 2’s complement. For example,
7FH + 03H + 05H + C4H + 00H + 01H = 14CH, round down carry 1 and take 4CH.
2’s complement of 4CH is B4H.
Step 2: (The low byte of CRC register) XOR (The first byte of command), and save the
result in CRC register.
Step 3: Right move one bit. Check the least significant bit (LSB) of CRC register. If the bit is
1, then (CRC register) XOR (A001H).
Step 4: Return to Step 3 until Step 3 has been executed for 8 times. Go to Step 5.
Step 5: Repeat the procedure from Step 2 to Step 4 until all byte is processing. Get the
result of CRC value.
Description: After calculating CRC value, fill in the low word of CRC first in command message,
and then fill in the high word of CRC. For example, if the result of CRC algorithm is 3794H, fill in
94H in low word and then 37H in high word.
ADR 01H
CMD 03H
01H (High)
Starting data address
01H (Low)
Number of data 00H (High)
(In Word) 02H (Low)
CRC Check Low 94H (Low)
CRC Check High 37H (High)
while( length-- ) {
reg_crc^= *data++;
for (j=0; j<8; j++ ) {
if( reg_crc & 0x01 ) { /*LSB(bit 0 ) = 1 */
reg_crc = (reg_crc >> 1)^0xA001;
} else {
reg_crc = (reg_crc>>1);
}
}
}
return reg_crc;
}
PC communication program example:
#include<stdio.h>
#include<dos.h>
#include<conio.h>
#include<process.h>
#define PORT 0x03F8 /* the address of COM 1 */
#define THR 0x0000
#define RDR 0x0000
#define BRDL 0x0000
#define IER 0x0001
#define BRDH 0x0001
#define LCR 0x0003
#define MCR 0x0004
#define LSR 0x0005
#define MSR 0x0006
unsigned char rdat[60];
/* read 2 data from address 0200H of ASD with address 1 */
unsigned char tdat[60]={‘:’,’0’,’1’,’0’,’3’,’0’,’2’,’0’,’0’,’0’,’0’,’0’,’2’,’F’,’8’,’\r’,’\n’};
void main() {
int I;
outportb(PORT+MCR,0x08); /* interrupt enable */
outportb(PORT+IER,0x01); /* interrupt as data in */
outportb(PORT+LCR,( inportb(PORT+LCR) | 0x80 ) );
/* the BRDL/BRDH can be access as LCR.b7 == 1 */
outportb(PORT+BRDL,12);
outportb(PORT+BRDH,0x00);
outportb(PORT+LCR,0x06); /* set prorocol
<7,E,1> = 1AH, <7,O,1> = 0AH
<8,N,2> = 07H <8,E,1> = 1BH
<8,O,1> = 0BH */
Parameters are divided into 8 groups, Group 0: Monitor Parameters, Group 1: Basic Parameters,
Group 2: Extension Parameters, Group 3: Communication Parameters, Group 4: Diagnosis
Parameters, Group 5: Motion Setting, Group 6 and Group 7: PR Definition.
Group 7 (P7-00~P7-27)
Corresponding Servo
Display Alarm Name Alarm Description
DO Status
Abnormal It is in error when DSP accesses Servo
AL017 ALM
EEPROM EEPROM. Off
Abnormal signal The encoder output exceeds the rated Servo
AL018 ALM
output output frequency. Off
Serial RS-232/485 communication is in error
Servo
AL019 Communication ALM
Off
Error
Serial RS-232/485 communication time out
Servo
AL020 Communication WARN
On
Time Out
Main Circuit Only one single phase is inputted in the
Servo
AL022 Power Lack main circuit power. WARN
Off
Phase
Early Warning Early Warning for Overload Servo
AL023 WARN
for Overload On
Encoder initial The magnetic field of the encoder U, V,
Servo
AL024 magnetic field W signal is in error. ALM
Off
error
The Internal of The internal memory of the encoder and
Servo
AL025 the Encoder is in the internal counter are in error. ALM
Off
Error
Unreliable The error of the internal data has been
Servo
AL026 internal data of detected for three times continuously. ALM
Off
the encoder
The Internal of The internal reset of the encoder is in
Servo
AL027 the Motor is in error. ALM
On
Error
Encoder voltage Charging circuit of the servo drive is not
error or the removed and the battery voltage is
Servo
AL028 internal of the higher than the specification (>3.8 V) or ALM
On
encoder is in the encoder signal is in error.
error
Gray code error Absolute position is in error. Servo
AL029 ALM
On
Motor Crash The motor crashes the equipment,
Servo
AL030 Error reaches the torque of P1-57 and ALM
Off
exceeds the time set by P1-58.
Incorrect wiring Incorrect wiring of the motor power line
of the motor U, V, W, GND or the connection Servo
AL031 ALM
power line U, V, between both is breakdown. Off
W, GND
Internal 1. Internal communication error of the
communication absolute encoder Servo
AL034 ALM
of the encoder is 2. Internal error of other type of Off
in error encoder
AL035 Encoder Encoder temperature exceeds the ALM Servo
Corresponding Servo
Display Alarm Name Alarm Description
DO Status
temperature protective range Off
exceeds the
protective range
Excessive Excessive Deviation of Full Closed-loop
Deviation of Full Position Control Servo
AL040 ALM
Closed-loop Off
Position Control
Communication Communication of CN5 (encoder) is
Servo
AL041 of CN5 is breakdown ALM
Off
breakdown
Analog input The analog voltage is over than the Servo
AL042 ALM
voltage error setting value of P1-83. Off
Warning of servo Warning of servo drive function overload
Servo
AL044 drive function WARN
On
overload
AL045 Wrong setting of The setting of E-gear ratio exceeds the
E-gear ratio range (1/50~25600). Thus, when re- Servo
ALM
power on the servo drive, an alarm off
occurs.
Due to battery undervoltage or the
The absolute Servo
AL060 failure of power supply, the encoder lost WARN
position is lost On
the internal record.
Encoder under The voltage of the absolute encoder is Servo
AL061 WARN
voltage lower than the specification On
The multi-turn of
The multi-turn of absolute encoder
absolute Servo
AL062 exceeds the maximum range: -32768 ~ WARN
encoder On
+32767
overflows
Encoder Encoder temperature exceeds the
AL067 temperature warning level. (But it is still within the WARN N/A
warning protective range.)
Absolute data
The sequence is wrong when reading Servo
AL068 transmitted via WARN
the absolute position via DIO. On
I/O is in error
Wrong motor Incremental motor is not allowed to Servo
AL069 ALM
type activate the absolute function. Off
The absolute The possible causes might be:
coordinate has 1. The motor is used for the first time Servo
AL06A WARN
not been 2. The battery had run dry but has On
initialized replaced a new one.
Encoder does Servo drive has not completely writing
not complete the barcode into encoder or the encoder
Servo
AL070 command which does not complete the command issued WARN
Off
is issued by by servo drive.
servo drive
AL083 Servo drive When the output current from servo ALM Servo
Corresponding Servo
Display Alarm Name Alarm Description
DO Status
outputs drive exceeds the setting level, ALE083 Off
excessive will be triggered to protect IGBT. This
current could avoid IGBT to be burned out
because of the excessive current.
The absolute The possible causes might be:
coordinate has 1. The motor is used for the first time Servo
AL085 WARN
not been 2. The battery had run dry but has On
initialized replaced a new one.
The servo drive The servo drive does not connect to
does not external regenerative resistor
connect to Servo
AL095 *This alarm is only for 5.5 kW and 7.5 WARN
external kW. On
regenerative
resistor
DSP Firmware EEPROM has not been reset after
Upgrade upgrading the firmware. The fault can
Servo
AL099 be cleared when firstly set P2-08 to 30. ALM
Off
Then set P2-08 to 28. And re-power on
the drive.
NOTE If the alarm occurs and is different from the alarm showed in Alarm of Servo
Drive, Alarm of CANopen Communication and Alarm of Motion Control,
please contact with distributors or technical personnel.
Alarm Display
AL001:Over current
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
The drive output is short- Check if the wiring between the Eliminate short-circuit and avoid
circuit motor and the drive is correct and metal conductor being exposed.
see if the wire is short-circuited.
The motor wiring is in Check if the wiring steps are correct Rewiring by following the wiring
error. when connecting the motor to the description from the user manual.
drive.
IGBT is abnormal The temperature of the heat sink is Send the drive back to the
abnormal distributors or contact with Delta
The control parameter Check if the setting value exceeds Setting back to the default setting
setting is in error. the default setting and then gradually adjust the value.
Unreasonable command Check if the command doing Less steep command used or filter
reasonable acceleration time. applying to smooth command.
AL002:Over voltage
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
The input voltage of the Use the voltmeter to see if the input Apply to the correct power supply
main circuit is higher voltage of the main circuit is within or serial voltage regulator.
than the rated allowable the rated allowable voltage value.
voltage. (please refer to Chapter 12.1)
Wrong power input Use the voltmeter to see if the Apply to the correct power supply
(incorrect power power system matches the or serial adaptor.
system) specification.
The hardware of the Use the voltmeter to see if the input Send the drive back to the
servo drive is damaged. voltage of the main circuit is within distributors or contact with Delta.
the rated allowable voltage value
but still shows the error.
AL003:Under voltage
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
The input voltage of the Check if the input voltage wiring of Re-confirm the voltage wiring.
main circuit is lower than the main circuit is normal.
the rated allowable
voltage.
No power supply for the Use the voltmeter to see if the Check the power switch
main circuit. voltage of the main circuit is normal.
Wrong power input Use the voltmeter to see if the Apply to the correct power supply
(incorrect power power system matches the or serial adaptor.
system) specification.
AL005:Regeneration Error
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
The regenerative resistor Check the connection of Reconnect the regenerative resistor
is unconnected or too regenerative resistor. or calculate the value of the
low regenerative resistor.
Parameter P1-53 is not Check if parameter P1-53 of Set parameter P1-53 of
set to zero when the regenerative resister is set to zero. regenerative resistor to zero when
regenerative resistor is it is not applying.
not in use.
Wrong parameter setting Check the setting value of Correctly reset the setting.
parameter P1-52 and P1-53.
AL006:Overload
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
Over the rated loading of Set parameter P0-02 to 11 and see Increase the motor capacity or
the drive and if the average torque [%] is over reduce the load.
continuously excessive 100% all the time.
using
The setting of the control
1. Check if there is any mechanical 1. Adjust the gain value of the
system parameter is vibration. control circuit.
inappropriate. 2. Check if the acceleration / 2. Slow down the acceleration /
deceleration constant are set too deceleration setting time.
fast.
Wrong wiring of the Check the wiring of U, V, W and the Correct wiring
motor and the encoder. encoder.
The encoder of the motor Send the drive back to the distributors or contact with Delta.
is defective.
AL007:Overspeed
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
Unreasonable command Use the scope to check if the signal Less steep command used or filter
of analog voltage is abnormal. applying to smooth command.
Inappropriate parameter Check if the setting of parameter Correctly set parameter P2-34 (the
setting P2-34 is too small (the condition of condition of over-speed warning).
over-speed warning).
AL011:Encoder Error
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
Wrong wiring of the Check if the wiring follows the Correct wiring
encoder suggested wiring of the user
manual.
The encoder is loose Check the drive connector of CN2 Install the encoder again
and encoder
Bad connection of the Check if the connection between Reconnect the wiring
encoder CN2 of the drive and the encoder of
the servo motor is loose
The encoder is damaged Check if the motor is damaged Change the motor
AL012:Adjustment Error
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
The analog input contact Measure if the voltage of the analog Correctly ground the analog input
is incorrectly set back to input contact is the same as the contact
zero ground voltage
The detection device is Reset the power supply If the error still occurs after reset,
damaged send the drive back to the
distributors or contact with Delta.
AL013:Emergency Stop
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
Press the emergency Check if the emergency stop button Activate emergency stop
stop button is enabled.
AL016:IGBT Overheat
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
Over the rated loading of Check if it is overloading or the Increase the motor capacity or
the drive and motor current is too high. reduce the load.
continuously excessive
using
The drive output is short- Check the drive output wiring Correct wiring
circuit
AL017:Abnormal EEPROM
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
It is in error when DSP Press the SHIFT Key on the panel The fault occurs when applying to
accesses EEPROM. and it shows EXGAB. the power. It means one of the
X = 1, 2, 3 parameters is over the reasonable
range. Please re-power on after
G=group code of the parameter
adjusting.
AB=hexadecimal of the parameter
If it shows E320A, it means it is The fault occurs in normal
parameter P2-10; If it shows E3610, operation. It means it is in error
it means it is parameter P6-16. when writing the parameter. The
Please check the parameter. alarm can be cleared by DI.ARST.
Abnormal hidden Press the SHIFT Key on the panel The fault occurs in parameter reset.
parameter and it shows E100X The setting of the drive is wrong.
Please set the correct type of the
drive.
Data in ROM is Press the SHIFT Key on the panel The fault occurs when it is servo-
damaged. and it shows E0001 on. Usually it is because the data in
ROM is damaged or there is no
data in ROM. Please send the drive
back to the distributors or contact
with Delta.
AL070:Encoder does not complete the command which is issued by servo drive
AL085:Regeneration Error
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
Choose wrong Check the connection of Calculate the value of the
regenerative resistor or regenerative resistor. regenerative resistor again and
does not connect to correctly set the value of P1-52 and
external regenerative P1-53. If issue persists, please
resistor send the drive back to the
distributors or contact with Delta.
Parameter P1-53 is not Check if parameter P1-53 of Set parameter P1-53 of
set to zero when the regenerative resister is set to zero. regenerative resistor to zero when
regenerative resistor is it is not applying.
not in use.
Wrong parameter setting Check the setting value of Correctly reset the value of P1-52
AL130:The accessing address of EEPROM is out of range when using CANopen PDO
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
The quantity of the data Check that when PDO is receiving NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
inside ROM is over the or sending, if the specified object Reset
planned space. It is enables EEPROM address exceeds
probably because the the limit.
software has been
updated. The data inside
ROM is stored by the old
version. Thus, it cannot
be used.
Absolute type:
The error occurs in following
situations:
1. Feedback register (FB_PUU)
overflows
2. After P1.01.Z is modified, the
system neither returns to the
original point nor conducts
homing procedure.
3. It does not conduct homing
procedure after the E-gear ratio
is modified (P1-44 and P1-45).
4. Returning to the original point is
triggered and the homing
procedure is not complete.
AL273:The accessing address of EEPROM is out of range when using CANopen object
Causes Checking Method Corrective Actions
The quantity of the data This alarm will not occur at the NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
inside ROM is over the moment. If it does, please contact Reset
planned space. It is the distributors.
probably because the
software has been
updated. The data inside
ROM is stored by the old
version. Thus, it cannot
be used.
AL555:System Failure
AL004 :The magnetic field of the motor is abnormal The alarm can be cleared after re-
power on.
AL009 :Excessive deviation of position control Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm
AL016 :The temperature of IGBT is abnormal Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm
AL022 :Main circuit power leak phase Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm
AL023 :Early warning for overload Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm
AL024 :Encoder initial magnetic field error The alarm can be cleared after re-
power on.
AL025 :The internal of the encoder is in error The alarm can be cleared after re-
power on.
AL026 :The encoder is in error The alarm can be cleared after re-
power on.
The alarm can be cleared after re-
AL027 :Encoder reset error
power on.
:The encoder is over voltage or the internal The alarm can be cleared after re-
AL028
of the encoder is in error power on.
The alarm can be cleared after re-
AL029 :Gray code error
power on.
:Incorrect wiring of the motor power line U, The alarm can be cleared after re-
AL031 power on.
V, W, GND
:Internal communication of the encoder is in The alarm can be cleared after re-
AL034
error power on.
The temperature sensor of motor
:Encoder temperature exceeds the
AL035 shall below 100℃. And the alarm
protective range
can be cleared after re-power on.
:The absolute coordinate has not been The alarm can be cleared after
AL06A
initialized initializing the absolute coordinate.
:Encoder does not complete the command The alarm can be cleared after re-
AL070
which is issued by servo drive power on.
AL083 :Servo drive outputs excessive current Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm.
AL095 :The servo drive does not connect to Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm.
external regenerative resistor
Firstly set P2-08 to 30. Then set it to
AL099 :DSP firmware upgrade 28. And the alarm will be cleared after
re-power on.
NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL111 :CANopen SDO receives buffer overflow
Reset
NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL112 :CANopen PDO receives buffer overflow
Reset
:Data Size error occurs when accessing NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL123
CANopen PDO Reset
:Data range error occurs when accessing NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL124
CANopen PDO Reset
:Error occurs when reading CANopen PDO NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL128
via EEPROM Reset
:Error occurs when writing CANopen PDO NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL129
via EEPROM Reset
:Enter the incorrect password when using NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL132
CANopen PDO Reset
:An error occurs when writing parameter via DI.Alm Reset or P0-01 = 0
AL213
PR:exceeds the range
:An error occurs when writing parameter via DI.Alm Reset or P0-01 = 0
AL215
PR:read-only
:An error occurs when writing parameter via Re-adjust PR command and parameter
AL217
PR:parameter locked
1. Turn DI.ARST on to clear the
AL231 :The setting of monitor item is out of range alarm.
2. Set P0-01 to 0.
:Data Size error occurs when accessing NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL265
CANopen object Reset
:Data range error occurs when accessing NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL267
CAN. Reset
AL26b :PDO is not allowed in CANopen object NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
Reset
:Error occurs when writing CANopen object NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL271
via EEPROM Reset
:Enter the incorrect password when using NMT: Reset node or 0x6040.Fault
AL277
CANopen object Reset
:NMT Reset command is received when Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm.
AL401
Servo On
AL404 :Value of PR special filter setting is too big Turn DI.ARST on to clear the alarm.
0.39 1.11 1.86 3.66 4.68 5.9 8.76 9.83 17.5 19.4 26.3 48 63
Unit: Arms
Input Current (1PH)
0.69 1.92 3.22 6.78 8.88 10.3 - - - - - - -
Unit: Arms
Continuous Output
Current 0.9 1.55 2.6 5.1 7.3 8.3 13.4 19.4 32.5 40 47.5 54.4 70
Unit: Arms
Cooling method Natural cooling Fan Cooling
Encoder Resolution
Incremental type: 20-bit (1280000 p/rev) ; Absolute type: 17-bit (1280000 p/rev)
(Servo Drive Resolution)
Main Circuit Control SVPWM (Space Vector Pulse Width Modulation) Control
Control Mode Auto / Manual
Command Source External analog command (DMCNET mode is not included) / Register
Smoothing Strategy Low-pass and S-curve filter
Torque Limit Via parameter settings or analog input
Bandwidth Maximum 1 kHz
Analog
Input
Command 10 K
Resistance
Input
Time
2.2 us
Constant
Command Source External analog command (DMCNET mode is not included) / Register
Smoothing Strategy Low-pass filter
Speed Limit Via parameter settings or analog input (DMCNET mode is not included)
Analog Monitor Output Monitor signal can set by parameters (Output voltage range: ±8 V)
Servo on, Fault reset, Gain switch, Pulse clear, Zero clamp, Command input reverse control,
Internal position command trigger, Torque limit, Speed limit, Internal position command
selection, Motor stop, Speed command selection, Speed / position mode switching, Speed /
torque mode switching, Torque / position mode switching, PT/PR command switching,
Input Emergency stop, Positive / negative limit, Original point, Forward / reverse operation torque
limit, Homing activated, E-CAM engage, Forward / reverse JOG input, Event trigger, E-gear N
selection, Pulse input prohibition
Digital *DMCNET mode is not included for the DI mentioned above. When applying DMCNET mode, it is suggested to use
Input/Output communication for DI input. Its DI only supports emergency stop, forward/reverse limit and homing.
A, B, Z Line Driver output
Servo on, Servo ready, Zero speed, Target speed reached, Target position reached, torque
Output limiting, Servo alarm, Brake control, Homing completed, Early warning for overload, Servo
warning, Position command overflows, Software negative limit (reverse direction), Software
positive limit (forward direction), Internal position command completed, Capture procedure
completed, Servo procedure completed, Master position area of E-CAM
Over current, Overvoltage, Under voltage, Overheat, Regeneration error, Overload, Excessive
speed deviation, Excessive position deviation, Encoder error, Adjustment error, Emergency
Protective Function stop, Negative / positive limit error, Excessive deviation of full-closed loop control, Serial
communication error, Rst leak phase, Serial communication timeout, Short-circuit protection of
terminal U, V, W and CN1, CN2, CN3
Communication Interface RS-232 / RS-485 / CANopen / USB / DMCNET
Installation
Indoors (avoid the direct sunlight), no corrosive fog (avoid fume, flammable gas and dust)
Site
Altitude Altitude 1000 m or lower above sea level
Atmospheric
86 kPa to 106 kPa
pressure
Operating o o o
Temperature 0 C ~ 55 C (If operating temperature is above 45 C, forced cooling will be required)
Storage o o
Environment
Temperature -20 C to 65 C
Note:
*1 When it is in rated load, the speed ratio is: the minimum speed (smooth operation) /rated speed.
*2 When the command is the rated speed, the velocity correction ratio is: (rotational speed with no load –
rotational speed with full load) / rated speed.
*3 TN system: The neutral point of the power system connects to the ground directly. The exposed metal
components connect to the ground via the protective earth conductor.
4 Please refer to section 11.4 for overload features.
Speed Control
1 : 5000 1 : 3000
Range *1
Command Source External analog command (DMCNET is not included) / Register
Smoothing Strategy Low-pass and S-curve filter
Torque Limit Via parameter settings or analog input
Bandwidth Maximum 1 kHz
0.01% or less at 0 to 100% load fluctuation
Speed Accuracy *2 0.01% or less at ± 10% power fluctuation
o o
0.01% or less at 0 C to 50 C ambient temperature fluctuation
Analog Voltage
tro
on
0 ~ ± 10 VDC
Command Input Range
Note:
*1 When it is in rated load, the speed ratio is: the minimum speed (smooth operation) /rated speed.
*2 When the command is the rated speed, the velocity correction ratio is: (rotational speed with no load –
rotational speed with full load) / rated speed.
*3 TN system: The neutral point of the power system connects to the ground directly. The exposed metal
components connect to the ground via the protective earth conductor.
4 Please refer to section 11.6 for overload features.
Rated power (kW) 0.05 0.1 0.2 0.4 0.4 0.75 0.75 1.0
Rated torque (N-m) *1 0.159 0.32 0.64 1.27 1.27 2.39 2.39 3.18
Max. torque (N-m) 0.477 0.96 1.92 3.82 3.82 7.16 7.14 8.78
Rated current (A) 0.69 0.90 1.55 2.60 2.60 5.10 3.66 4.25
Max. instantaneous current
2.05 2.70 4.65 7.80 7.80 15.3 11.0 12.37
(A)
Power rating (kW/s) 12.27 27.7 22.4 57.6 24.0 50.4 29.6 38.6
2
Rotor inertia (× 10-4kg.m ) 0.0206 0.037 0.177 0.277 0.68 1.13 1.93 2.62
Mechanical constant (ms) 1.14 0.75 0.80 0.53 0.74 0.63 1.72 1.20
Torque constant-KT (N-m/A) 0.23 0.36 0.41 0.49 0.49 0.47 0.65 0.75
Voltage constant-KE
9.8 13.6 16.0 17.4 18.5 17.2 24.2 27.5
(mV/(r/min))
Armature resistance (Ohm) 12.7 9.30 2.79 1.55 0.93 0.42 1.34 0.897
Armature inductance (mH) 26.0 24.0 12.07 6.71 7.39 3.53 7.55 5.7
Electric constant (ms) 2.05 2.58 4.30 4.30 7.96 8.36 5.66 6.35
Weight (kg) (without brake) 0.42 0.5 1.2 1.6 2.1 3.0 2.9 3.8
Weight (kg) (with brake) -- 0.8 1.5 2.0 2.9 3.8 3.69 5.5
Radial max. loading (N) 78.4 78.4 196 196 245 245 245 245
Approvals
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature
which is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
Material: Aluminum – F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to
decelerate or as the dynamic brake.
Cᇞ10 Cᇞ13
ECMA Series
10 20 30
Cᇞ10 Cᇞ13
ECMA Series
10 20 30
Approvals
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature
which is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
Material: Aluminum – F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to
decelerate or as the dynamic brake.
Rated power (kW) 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.0 3.0 3.5 0.3 0.6 0.9
Rated torque (N-m) *1 2.39 4.77 7.16 9.55 9.55 14.32 16.71 2.86 5.73 8.59
Max. torque (N-m) 7.16 14.3 21.48 28.65 28.65 42.97 50.13 8.59 17.19 21.48
Rated current (A) 2.9 5.6 8.3 11.01 11.22 16.1 19.2 2.5 4.8 7.5
Max. instantaneous
8.7 16.8 24.9 33.03 33.66 48.3 57.6 7.5 14.4 22.5
current (A)
Power rating (kW/s) 7.0 27.1 45.9 62.5 26.3 37.3 50.8 10.0 39.0 66.0
Rotor inertia
2 8.17 8.41 11.18 14.59 34.68 54.95 54.95 8.17 8.41 11.18
(× 10-4kg.m )
Mechanical constant (ms) 1.91 1.51 1.10 0.96 1.62 1.06 1.08 1.84 1.40 1.06
Torque constant-KT
0.83 0.85 0.87 0.87 0.85 0.89 0.87 1.15 1.19 1.15
(N-m/A)
Voltage constant-KE
30.9 31.9 31.8 31.8 31.4 32.0 32.0 42.5 43.8 41.6
(mV/(r/min))
Armature resistance
0.57 0.47 0.26 0.174 0.119 0.052 0.052 1.06 0.82 0.43
(Ohm)
Armature inductance (mH) 7.39 5.99 4.01 2.76 2.84 1.38 1.38 14.29 11.12 6.97
Electric constant (ms) 12.96 12.88 15.31 15.86 23.87 26.39 26.39 13.55 13.50 16.06
Radial max. loading (N) 490 490 490 490 1176 1470 490 490 490 490
IP Rating IP65 (use the waterproof connector and shaft seal installation (or oil seal) model)
Approvals
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature which
is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
Material: Aluminum – F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to
decelerate or as the dynamic brake.
Rated power (kW) 0.5 0.85 1.3 1.8 3.0 4.5 5.5 7.5 11 15
*1
Rated torque (N-m) 3.18 5.41 8.34 11.48 19.10 28.65 35.01 47.74 70 95.4
Max. torque (N-m) 8.92 13.8 23.3 28.7 57.29 71.62 87.53 119.36 175 224.0
Rated current (A) 3.9 7.1 12.6 13.0 19.4 32.5 40.0 47.5 51.8 67.0
Max. instantaneous current 12.1 19.4 38.6 36.0 58.2 81.3 100.0 118.8 129.5 162
(A)
Power rating (kW/s) 9.8 21.52 34.78 52.93 66.4 105.5 122.9 159.7 144.9 201.8
2
Rotor inertia (× 10-4kg.m ) 10.3 13.6 20 24.9 54.95 77.75 99.78 142.7 338 451
Mechanical constant (ms) 2.8 2.43 1.62 1.7 1.28 0.92 0.96 0.63 1.38 1.23
Torque constant-KT 0.82 0.76 0.66 0.88 0.98 0.88 0.88 1.01 1.37 1.42
(N-m/A)
Voltage constant-KE 29.5 29.2 24.2 32.2 35.0 32.0 31.0 35.5 49.0 50.0
(mV/(r/min))
Motor resistance (Ohm) 0.624 0.38 0.124 0.185 0.077 0.032 0.025 0.015 0.026 0.0184
Motor inductance (mH) 7.0 4.77 1.7 2.6 1.27 0.89 0.60 0.40 0.65 0.48
Electric constant (ms) 11.22 12.55 13.71 14.05 16.5 27.8 24.0 26.7 24.79 26.09
Weight (kg) (without brake) 6.3 8.6 9.4 10.5 18.5 23.5 30.5 40.5 56.4 75.0
Weight (kg) (with brake) 7.7 10.0 10.8 11.9 22.5 29.0 36.0 46.0 68.4 87.0
Radial max. loading (N) 490 490 490 490 1470 1470 1764 1764 3300 3300
Axial max. loading (N) 98 98 98 98 490 490 588 588 1100 1100
Power rating (kW/s)
8.8 19.78 32.66 50.3 63.9 101.8 119.4 156.6 141.4 197.1
(with brake)
Rotor inertia
-4 2 11.5 14.8 21.3 26.2 57.06 80.65 102.70 145.55 346.5 461.8
(× 10 kg.m ) (with brake)
Mechanical constant (ms) 3.12 2.65 1.73 1.79 1.33 0.96 0.99 0.64 1.41 1.25
(with brake)
Brake holding torque
10.0 10.0 10.0 10.0 25.0 55.0 55.0 55.0 115 115
[Nt-m (min)] *2
Brake power consumption
o 19 19.0 19.0 19.0 20.4 19.9 19.9 19.9 28.8 28.8
(at 20 C) [W]
Brake release time 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
[ms (Max)]
IP Rating IP65 (use the waterproof connector and shaft seal installation (or oil seal) model)
Approvals
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature
which is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
Material: Aluminum – F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to decelerate
or as the dynamic brake.
3 If desire to reach the max. torque limit of motor 250%, it is suggest to use the servo drive with higher
watt.
C△06 C△08
ECMA
04□H 07□H
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature
which is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
Material: Aluminum – F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to decelerate
or as the dynamic brake.
3 If desire to reach the max. torque limit of motor 250%, it is suggest to use the servo drive with higher
watt.
04 07 07 10 10 20 30
Rated power (kW) 0.4 0.75 0.75 1 1.0 2.0 3.0
*1
Rated torque (N-m) 1.27 2.39 2.39 3.18 3.18 6.37 9.55
Max. torque (N-m) 3.82 7.16 7.14 8.78 9.54 19.1 28.65
Rated speed (r/min) 3000 3000
Rated current (A) 1.62 3.07 2.16 2.4 4.15 7.09 9.8
Max. instantaneous current
4.85 9.5 6.37 7.17 12.46 21.28 29.99
(A)
Power rating (kW/s) 58.2 50.4 29.6 38.6 38.2 91.2 71.8
Rotor inertia
2 0.277 1.13 1.93 2.62 2.65 4.45 12.7
(× 10-4kg.m )
Mechanical constant (ms) 0.47 0.66 1.56 1.06 0.77 0.58 0.99
Torque constant-KT (N-m/A) 0.79 0.78 1.12 1.29 0.77 0.9 0.97
Voltage constant-KE
30.6 28.24 42 50.9 29.0 34.4 37.3
(mV/(r/min))
Armature resistance (Ohm) 3.95 1.22 3.62 2.58 0.617 0.388 0.269
Armature inductance (mH) 21.3 10.68 21.2 15.28 6.03 4.62 3.55
Electric constant (ms) 5.39 8.75 5.85 5.93 9.77 11.8 13.2
Insulation class Class A (UL), Class B (CE)
Radial max. loading (N) 53.8 245 245 245 490 490 490
Axial max. loading (N) 0.3 98 98 98 98 98 98
Power rating (kW/s)
0.51 48.4 29.3 37.9 30.4 82 65.1
(with brake)
Rotor inertia
-4 2 1.3 1.18 1.95 2.67 3.33 4.95 14.0
(× 10 kg.m ) (with brake)
Mechanical constant (ms)
6.5 0.65 1.57 1.08 0.96 0.65 1.09
(with brake)
Brake holding torque
10.0 2.5 2.5 2.5 8 8 10.0
[Nt-m (min)] *2
04 07 07 10 10 20 30
Brake power consumption
o 18.5 8.5 8.2 8.2 18.5 18.5 19.0
(at 20 C) [W]
Brake release time
10 10 10 10 10 10 10
[ms (Max)]
Brake pull-in time
70 70 70 70 70 70 70
[ms (Max)]
Vibration grade (μm) 15
o o o
Operating temperature ( C) 0 C to 40 C
o o o
Storage temperature ( C) -10 C to 80 C
Operating humidity 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing)
Approvals
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature
which is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
Material: Aluminum – F80, F130, F180
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to
decelerate or as the dynamic brake.
05 10 15 20 20
K△13 K△18
ECMA Series
500 W 1 kW 1.5 kW 2 kW 2 kW
05 10 15 20 20
Brake release time
10 10 10 10 10
[ms (Max)]
Brake pull-in time
70 70 70 70 70
[ms (Max)]
Vibration grade (μm) 15
o
Operating temperature ( C) 0℃ ~ 40℃
o
Storage temperature ( C) -10℃~80℃
Operating humidity 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing)
Approvals
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature
which is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
Material: Aluminum – F80, F130, F180
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to
decelerate or as the dynamic brake.
Insulation class -
L△18
ECMA Series
30 45 55 75
o o o
Operating temperature ( C) 0 C to 40 C
o o o
Storage temperature ( C) -10 C to 80 C
Operating humidity 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing)
Approvals
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature
which is suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-__08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm
ECMA-__22: 650mm x 650mm x 35mm
Material type: Aluminum – F80, F130, F180, F220
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to
decelerate or as the dynamic brake.
05 08 13 09
Rated power (kW) 0.5 0.85 1.3 0.9
L△13 M△13
05 08 13 09
Storage temperature (˚C) -10 ~ 80
Note:
*1 The rated torque is the continuous permissible torque between 0~40˚C operating temperature which is
suitable for the following heat sink dimension.
ECMA-_ _ 08:250mm x 250mm x 6mm
ECMA-_ _ 13:400mm x 400mm x 20mm
ECMA-_ _ 18:550mm x 550mm x 30mm
ECMA-_ _ 22:650mm x 650mm x 35mm
Material type: Aluminum –F80, F130, F180, F220
*2 The built-in brake of the servo motor is for remaining the item in stop status. Do not use it to decelerate or
as the dynamic brake.
0.477
(300%)
Acceleration /
Deceleration area
0.159
(100%)
0.095 Continuous
(60%) area
Speed (r/min)
3000 5000
ECMA-C1040F□S
Torque
(N-m)
7.16
(300%)
Acceleration /
Deceleration
area
2.39
(100%)
1.43 Continuous
(60%) area
Speed
3000 5000 (r/min)
ECMA-C10807□S, ECMA-C10807□H
Torque (N-m)
28.65
(300%)
Acceleration/
Deceleration
area
9.55
(100%)
6.40 Continuous
(67%) area
Speed (r/min)
3000 4500
ECMA-C∆1330□4
50.13
(300%) 8.92
(280%)
Acceleration/ Acceleration /
Deceleration Deceleration
area 5.1 area
(160%)
16.71 3.18
(100%) (100%)
11.20 Continuous Continuous
1.59
(67%) area area
(50%)
Speed (r/min) Speed (r/min)
2000 3000 1500 2300 3000
ECMA-E∆1835□S ECMA-F11305□S
Torque (N-m)
28.7
(250%)
Acceleration /
Deceleration
11.48 area
(100%)
5.74 Continuous
(50%) area
Speed (r/min)
1500 2200 3000
ECMA-F∆1318□S
Torque (N-m)
175
(250%)
Acceleration
/Deceleration
70 area
(100%)
52.5
Continuous
(75%) area
Speed (r/min)
1500 2000
ECMA-F1221B□3
3.82
(300%)
Acceleration /
Deceleration
area
1.27
(100%)
0.762 Continuous
(60%) area
Speed (r/min)
3000 5000
ECMA-J∆0604□S
9.54 19.11
(300%) (300%)
Acceleration/ Acceleration/
Deceleration Deceleration
area area
3.18 6.37
(100%) (100%)
1.91 Continuous 3.82 Continuous
(60%) area (60%) area
Speed(r/min) Speed (r/min)
3000 5000 3000 5000
ECMA-J∆1010□S ECMA-J∆1020□S
Torque (N-m)
Torque (N-m)
14.32
28.66 (300%)
(300%)
Acceleration
Acceleration /Deceleration
/Deceleration area
area
4.77
9.55 (100%)
(100%) 3.2 Continuous
6.4 Continuous
(67%) area
area
(67%)
Speed (r/min) Speed (r/min)
3000 4500 2000 3000
ECMA-J∆1330□4 ECMA-K∆1310□S
Torque (N-m)
Torque (N-m)
28.66
21.5 (300%)
(300%)
Acceleration/
Acceleration Deceleration
/Deceleration
area
area
7.16 9.55
(100%) (100%)
4.8 Continuous 6.4 Continuous
(67%) area (67%) area
Speed (r/min) Speed (r/min)
2000 3000 2000 3000
ECMA-K∆1315□S ECMA-K∆1820□S
8.92 13.80
(280%) (255%)
Acceleration/
Deceleration Acceleration
5.1 area /Deceleration
(160%) area
3.18 5.39
(100%) (100%)
Continuous 2.70 Continuous
1.59
area area
(50%) (50%)
Speed (r/min) Speed (r/min)
1500 2300 3000 1500 3000
ECMA-LΔ1305□S ECMA-L∆1308□S
Torque (N-m)
57.29
(300%)
Acceleration
/Deceleration
area
19.10
(100%)
9.55 Continuous
area
(50%)
Speed (r/min)
1500 3000
ECMA-L∆1830□S
Torque (N-m)
21.48
(250%)
Acceleration /
Deceleration
8.59 area
(100%)
4.3 Continuous
(50%) area
Speed (r/min)
1000 2000
ECMA-M∆1309□S
Cause of overload
1) When the motor operates over the rated torque, the operation time is too long
2) The inertia ratio is set too big and frequently accelerate / decelerate
3) Connection error between the power cable and encoder wiring
4) Servo gain setting error and cause resonance of the motor
5) The motor with brake operates without releasing the brake
Medium and Medium-High Inertia Series (ECMA E1, F1, K1 and L1 Series)
Weight
1.5 (3.3)
NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)).
2) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Weight
2.0 (4.4)
NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)).
2) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Weight
2.89 (6.36)
NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)).
2) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Weight
4.4 (10.0)
NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)).
2) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Weight
5.5 (12.1)
NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)).
2) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Weight
5.9 (13)
NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)).
2) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Weight
20 (44)
NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)).
2) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Power A B C D E Weight
750 W~ 1.5 kW 216 (8.50) 203 (7.99) 82 (3.23) 62 (2.44) 203 (7.99) 2.89 (6.36)
2 kW ~ 5.5 kW 245 (9.65) 205.4 (8.09) 123 (4.88) 107 (4.21) 230 (9.06) 5.5 (12.1)
Power A B C D E Weight
7.5 kW 254.2 (10.01) 205.5 (8.09) 136 (5.35) 107 (4.21) 247 (9.72) 5.5 (12.1)
NOTE
ØLBh7
ØSh6
□LC
LB 70( 00.030 ) 70( 00.030 ) 70( 00.030 ) 80( 00.030 ) 80( 00.030 )
LL
112.3 138.3 151.1 130.2 153.2
(without brake)
LL
152.8 178 189 161.3 184.3
(with brake)
LS 27 32 32 30 30
LR 30 35 35 35 35
LE 3 3 3 3 3
LG 8 8 8 8 8
LW 20 25 25 20 20
RH 11 15.5 15.5 13 13
WK 5 6 6 5 5
W 5 6 6 5 5
T 5 6 6 5 5
M4 M6 M6 M5 M5
TP
Depth 15 Depth 20 Depth 20 Depth 15 Depth 15
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
Introduction
Delta’s absolute system includes an ASDA-A2 series servo drive, an ECMA series servo motor
with an absolute encoder and a backup battery box for an absolute encoder. An ECMA series
servo motor with an absolute encoder has an encoder which is able to rotate and tell the servo
motor the actual position when the power is turned on. An absolute encoder in an ECMA series
servo motor will constantly record the actual positions by its built-in coordinate system at any time.
So the real position of the servo motor will be measured and recorded even if the motor shaft
rotates after the power is turned off.
An ECMA series servo motor with an absolute encoder is essential and must be connected with an
ASDA-A2 series servo drive for a Delta’s absolute system. When an ECMA series servo motor with
an incremental encoder is connected to an ASDA-A2 series servo drive, if the users enable the
servo parameters for absolute system, a fault code, AL069 will be shown on the drive’s LCD
display to alert that an error occurs. When AL069 is displayed, please examine if the connected
servo motor is a servo motor with an absolute encoder. While using absolute motor, as soon as it
applies to the power, the motor speed cannot lower than 250rpm. When operating in battery mode,
make sure the maximum speed does not exceed 200rpm. The model name of a servo motor with
an absolute encoder is shown as below
One servo drive uses one single battery box. Two servo drives can share a dual battery box. We
recommend the users to choose Delta’s backup battery boxes and Delta’s encoder connection
cables for Delta’s absolute systems for wiring and connection. Please perform the installation in
order as specified in the quick start and user manual when connecting to an absolute system.
Regarding the descriptions and specifications of battery boxes and corresponding accessories,
please refer to the contents in the following sections.
12.1.1 Specifications
Precautions
Please thoroughly understand and observe the following safety precautions. Failure to observe
these precautions may void warranty! In order to prevent damage and danger, please use batteries
in accordance with the specified specification.
Do not use the product in a potentially explosive environment. Install the product in a
clean and dry location free from corrosive and inflammable gases or liquids.
Do not place the battery dispersedly to prevent short circuiting and accidents.
Do not short circuit the positive pole and the negative pole of the batteries or install
batteries in reverse polarity.
To prevent electric energy loss and lifetime reduction, it is recommended to use new
batteries only.
Do not store batteries within an ambient temperature above +100°C. Failure to observe
this precaution may cause fire or explosion.
The batteries are non-rechargeable. Do not charge the batteries or explosion may
result.
Do not directly solder the battery surface.
Battery Specifications
Type ER14505
Weight Approx. 19 g
Battery Liffe
Above fig
gure comes from EVE E
Energy Co. ER14505
E Disc
charge Charracteristics
(1) The ab
bove figure illustrates the discha
arge currentt curve gen
nerated by constant current
c test..
Accord
ding to the testing
t resu
ult shown on
n the graph
h above, wh
hen the pow
wer consum
mption of an
n
absolutte encoderr is 65uA or
o lower, iff the voltag
ge of the battery
b keeeps 3V or higher, the
e
(Note)
expecte
ed battery life is about 21900hrr, approxim
mately 2.5 years
y . Therefore, the lowestt
voltage
e level of ba
attery for an absolute e
encoder is set
s to 3.1V.
(2) The ba
attery life exxpectancy is
s about 5 ye
ears and is able to prov
vide 3.6V oor higher voltage underr
midity condit ions.
normall temperature and hum
N
NOTE easured wh
The battery life was me
T hen one sin
ngle batteryy box is con
nnecting to
o servo drive and on e servo mo
one otor.
Revision Dece
ember 2014 12-3
3
ASDA-A2 Chapter 12 Absolute System
Weight
44 g
Units: mm
45
26
64.5
Weight
80 g
R2
. 5
Units: mm
L
Title Model Name
mm inch
1 ASD-A2EB0003 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-A2EB0005 5000 100 197 4
Connection method:
Please conduct the wiring according to the following instructions. Wrong wiring might
cause battery explosion.
Quick *1
Connector
Battery box
B. Military Connector
Delta part number: ASD-A2EB1003, ASD-A2EB1005
L
Title Model Name
mm inch
1 ASD-A2EB1003 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-A2EB1005 5000 100 197 4
Connection method:
Please conduct the wiring according to the following instructions. Wrong wiring might
cause battery explosion.
Detail A
Title Part No. Manufacturer
Housing A2004H00-2P JWT
Terminal A2004WV0-2P JWT
Detail B
Title Part No. Manufacturer
Housing A2004H00-2P JWT
Terminal A2004TOP-2 JWT
Detail A, B
Title Part No. Manufacturer
Housing A2004H00-2P JWT
Terminal A2004TOP-2 JWT
12.2 Installation
NOTE This is the wiring diagram for connecting to a single battery box. The scale of the
objects does not match the dimensions as shown in the drawing above. For different models of AC
servo drives and motors, the connection cables may differ.
1* and 2* Please refer to section 12.1.3.
3* Definition of CN2 connector
Please conduct the wiring according to the following instructions. Wrong wiring might
cause battery explosion.
CN2 Connector Motor Connector
Terminal Military Quick
Pin No Function and Description
Symbol Connector Connector
Serial communication signal
5 T+ A 1
input/output (+)
Serial communication signal
4 T- B 4
input/output (-)
7 BAT+ Battery 3.6V C 2
9 BAT- Battery ground D 5
14, 16 +5V Power+5V S 7
13, 15 GND Power ground R 8
- Shield Shield L 9
NOTE This is the wiring diagram for connecting to a single battery box. The scale of the
objects does not match the dimensions as shown in the drawing above. For different models of AC
servo drives and motors, the connection cables may differ.
1* Make sure the battery box is firmly fixed with this connection method.
2* Connect to power base on single battery box, see the descriptions below:
Pin No Terminal Symbol Connector Cable
1 BAT+ Red
1 2 2 BAT- Black
NOTE
This is the wiring diagram for connecting to a single battery box. The scale of the objects does not
match the dimensions as shown in the drawing above. For different models of AC servo drives and
motors, the connection cables may differ.
1* and 2* Please refer to section 12.1.3.
3* Definition of CN2 connector
Please conduct the wiring according to the following instructions. Wrong wiring might
cause battery explosion.
CN2 Connector Motor Connector
Terminal Military Quick
Pin No Function and Description
Symbol Connector Connector
Serial communication
5 T+ A 1
signal input/output (+)
Serial communication
4 T- B 4
signal input/output (-)
7 BAT+ Battery 3.6V C 2
9 BAT- Battery ground D 5
14, 16 +5V Power+5V S 7
13, 15 GND Power ground R 8
- Shield Shield L 9
NOTE
This is the wiring diagram for connecting to a single battery box. The scale of the objects does not
match the dimensions as shown in the drawing above. For different models of AC servo drives and
motors, the connection cables may differ.
1* and 2* Please refer to section 12.1.3.
3* Definition of CN8 connector
Please conduct the wiring according to the following instructions. Wrong wiring might
cause battery explosion.
Pin No Terminal Symbol
1 BAT+
2 BAT-
Heat Shrink
Tube
Clip
Parameter Settings:
1. The AL060 will be cleared when the coordinate system has been initialized.
PR mode: The absolute coordinate system will be reset after any homing operation under PR
mode.
Other modes: Two methods can be used to initialize the coordinated system. One is via digital
inputs described in section 12.3.4, and another one is applying parameters in section 12.3.5.
2. For an initialized system when every time the power is turned on, the host controller can read
the absolute coordinate data via digital inputs and digital outputs (see section 12.3.6) or
parameters with communication (see section 12.2.6). Through the settings of parameter P2-70,
the host controller can read the coordinated data in PUU (see section 12.3.3) or in number of
turn plus the number of pulse within one turn (see section 12.3.2).
In addition, there are 1280000 pulses (0~1279999) in one rotation. Please pay attention on its
direction. The communication or digital inputs/digital outputs can be used to read it.
Pulse number for the distance = m (turn) × 1280000 + pulse number within one turn
(0~1279999)
Example 1:
When P1-44=128 and P1-45=10, there are 100000 PUU for motor to rotate one turn. 2147483647
÷ 100000 ≒ 21474.8. The limit to trigger the fault AL289 is 21474.8 (< 32767).
Example 2:
When P1-44=128 and P1-45=1, there are 10000 PUU for motor to rotate one turn. 2147483647 ÷
10000 ≒ 214748.3. The limit to trigger the fault AL062 is 32767 (< 214748.3).
PUU
0 ...... ......
-2147483648
AL289 AL289
NOTE When an absolute system has been initialized, if the parameter P1-01 Z
setting, P1-44, and P1-45 be changed, the absolute coordinate system will be
destroyed. A homing procedure is necessary at that moment.
TS(ms) TQ(ms)
Min. P2-09+2
Max. P2-09+10
Figure 12.3 The controlling chart for initializing an absolute system via digital inputs/outputs
When Bit 0 is 1 in P2-70, the PULSE number can be read by using digital inputs and outputs. The
frame is as below.
Explanation:
Check Sum = (((((((WORD_0+0xA700) XOR WORD_1)+0x605A) XOR WORD_2)+0x30A5) XOR
WORD_3)+0x5A06)
Note:
The setting in P2-70 with digital inputs/outputs communication can be used to read PULSE number
or PUU data with below signal communication sequence.
⑯. If there doesn’t have any error occurred during communication course for the host controller to
finish bit 0 to bit 79 (80 bits data), the functions of DI4, DO2, DO3 will be changed back to their
original functions before communication cycle started.
NOTE
If ABSW does not go back to high level signal after the changing of ABSE for signal low to high
that is a sign of error occurring, there must be some other errors existing. Please check if the
coordinate data still there, the voltage level of battery, or overflowing on the coordinate value.
A new communication cycle can be started only all of these errors been removed.
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Address: 028CH
P2-70 MRS Read Data Format Selection
028DH
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Settings:
Bit7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0
AL.289 (PU
UU), AL.062
2 (pulse).
Bit3 ~ Bit15: Re
eserved. Mu
ust be set to
o 0.
Adddress: 0288EH
P2-71■
■ CAP Absolute Position Homing
02
28FH
Operaational Reelated Section: N/A
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: N/A
Data Size:
S 16-bit
mat: Hexa
Form adecimal
Adddress: 00662H
P0-49■
■ UAP Renew Encoder
E Ab
bsolute Po
osition
00
063H
Opera
ational Reelated Section: N/A
Pane
el / Software
e Com
mmunication
n
Interfa
ace:
ault: 0x0
Defa
Control
ALL
Mo
ode:
U
Unit: N/A
Data Size:
S 16-bit
mat: Hexa
Form adecimal
Revision Dece
ember 2014 12-25
5
ASDA-A2 Chapter 12 Absolute System
well. While this setting is activated, the current position of the motor
will be reset as the target position of position command (same
function as CCLR).
Address: 0064H
P0-50★ APSTS Absolute Coordinate System Status
0065H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: N/A
Format: Hexadecimal
Settings:
Bit7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0
Address: 0066H
P0-51★ APR Encoder Absolute Position (Multiturn)
0067H
Operational Related Section: N/A
Panel / Software Communication
Interface:
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: rev
Format: Decimal
Settings: While the Bit 1 of P2-70 is set to read the encoder pulse number, this
parameter represents the turns of encoder absolute position. While the
Bit 1 of P2-70 is set to read the PUU number, this parameter becomes
disabled and the setting value of this parameter is 0.
Default: 0x0
Control
ALL
Mode:
Format: Decimal
Settings:While the Bit 1 of P2-70 is set to read the pulse number, this parameter
represents the pulse number of encoder absolute position. While the Bit
1 of P2-70 is set to read the PUU number, this parameter represents
PUU number of motor absolute position.
Address: 0004H
P0-02 STS Drive Status
0005H
Operational Related Section:
Panel / Software Communication
Interface: 7.2
Default: 00
Control
ALL
Mode:
Unit: -
Range: 00 ~ 127
Format: DEC
05: Error pulse number (after the scaling of electronic gear ratio)
(Encoder unit) [Pulse]
16:IGBT temperature
38:It display the battery voltage [0.1 Volt ]. For example, if it displays
36, it means the battery voltage is 3.6 V.
ABSE When DI.ABSE is ON, it is in ABS mode. DI.ABSQ, DI.ABSC, Level ALL
DI.ABSR, DI.ABSD and DI.ABSC are enabled. Triggered
When DI.ABSE is ON, the function of DI4, DO2, and DO3 will be
disabled. Function of DI4 will be ASDQ, DO2 will be ABSR and
DO3 will be ABSD.
Setting Value: When DI.ABSE is ON, DI4 inputs ABSQ signal, function set by P2-13 is
disabled.
Trigger Control
DI Name Function Description of Digital Input (DI) Method Mode
ABSQ is During I/O transmission, Handshaking signal will be sent to the Rising / ALL
servo drive by the controller. When DI.ABSQ is OFF, it means the Falling-
always controller issues Request ; DI.ABSQ is ON means the controller edged
inputted has already recdived ABSD signal. When DI.ABSE is ON, this DI Triggered
is enabled. Please refer to diagram 13.4 for detailed description.
by DI4
ABSC When DI.ABSC is ON, multi-turn data stored in absolute encoder Rising- ALL
will be cleared. When DI.ABSE is ON, this function is enabled. edge
Triggered
ABSR is DO.ABSR is OFF means the Request sent by ABSQ has been Level ALL
received. DO.ABSR is ON means the data that is outputted by Triggered
always ABSD is valid. When DI.ABSE is ON, this DO is enabled. Please
outputted refer to diagram 12.4 for detailed description.
by DO2
Setting Value: When DI.ABSE is ON, DO3 outputs ABSD signal, function set by P2-20 is
disabled.
Trigger Control
DO Name Function Description of Digital Output (DO) Method Mode
ABSD is Position data of ABS is outputted. The data is valid when ABSR is Level ALL
ON. When DI.ABSE is ON, this DO is enabled. Please refer to Triggered
always diagram 13.4 for detailed description.
outputted
by DO3
Setting Value:0x0D
Trigger Control
DO Name Function Description of Digital Output (DO) Method Mode
Encoder voltage error or Charging circuit of the servo drive is not removed and
AL028 the internal of the the battery voltage is higher than the specification
encoder is in error (>3.8 V) or the encoder signal is in error.
The absolute position is Due to battery under voltage or the failure of power
AL060
lost supply, the encoder lost the internal record.
Absolute data transmitted The sequence is wrong when reading the absolute
AL068
via I/O is in error position via DIO.
Feedback position
AL289 Feedback position counter overflows.
counter overflows
Power Connectors
10SL-4S
Power Cables
L
Title Part No.
mm inch
1 ASD-ABPW0003 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-ABPW0005 5000 100 197 4
L
Title Part No.
mm inch
1 ASD-CAPW5403 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-CAPW5405 5000 100 197 4
L
Title Part No.
mm inch
1 ASD- ABPW0103 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD- ABPW0105 5000 100 197 4
L
Title Part No.
mm inch
1 ASD- CAPW5103 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD- CAPW5105 5000 100 197 4
L (80 mm)
(3.15 inch)
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-CAPW10
003 3
3106A-20-1
18S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-CAPW10
005 3
3106A-20-1
18S 5000 1000 74
197
(50mm m)
(1.97 innch)
L (80 mm)
(3.15 inch)
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-CAPW11
103 3
3106A-20-1
18S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-CAPW11
105 3
3106A-20-1
18S 5000 1000 74
197
Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW
A 1203, ASD--CAPW1205
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-CAPW12
203 3
3106A-20-1
18S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-CAPW12
205 3
3106A-20-1
18S 5000 1000 74
197
Revision Dece
ember 2014 A-5
5
Appendix A A
Accessories ASDA-A2
2
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-CAPW13
303 3
3106A-20-1
18S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-CAPW13
305 3
3106A-20-1
18S 5000 1000 74
197
L (80 mm)
(3.15 inch)
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-A2PW10
003 3
3106A-20-1
18S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-A2PW10
005 3
3106A-20-1
18S 5000 1000 74
197
(50mm))
(1.97 inchh)
L (80 mm)
(3.15 inch)
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-A2PW11
103 3
3106A-20-1
18S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-A2PW11
105 3
3106A-20-1
18S 5000 1000 74
197
L
Title Part No. Straight
mm inch
1 ASD-CAPW2003 3106A-20-18S 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-CAPW2005 3106A-20-18S 5000 100 197 4
L
Title Part No. Straight
mm inch
1 ASD-CAPW2103 3106A-20-18S 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-CAPW2105 3106A-20-18S 5000 100 197 4
L (100 mm)
(3.94 inch)
L
Title Part No. Straight
mm inch
1 ASD-CAPW2203 3106A-20-18S 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-CAPW2205 3106A-20-18S 5000 100 197 4
(800mm)
(3.155 inch)
L (100 mm)
(3.94 inch)
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-CAPW23
303 3
3106A-20-1
18S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-CAPW23
305 3
3106A-20-1
18S 5000 1000 74
197
L
Title
e Part No. Straight
mm in
nch
1 AS
SD-CAPW32
203 M
MS 3106-24--11S 3000 1000 84
118
2 AS
SD-CAPW32
205 M
MS 3106-24--11S 5000 1000 74
197
L L1
Item Part No.. Straight
mm in
nch mm inch
1 A
ASD-CAPW3
3303 MS
S 3106-24-1 1S 3000100 84
118 31000100 1 4
122
2 A
ASD-CAPW3
3305 MS
S 3106-24-1 1S 5000100 74
197 51000100 2 4
201
Enco
oder Conn
nectors
Revision Dece
ember 2014 A-9
9
Appendix A Accessories ASDA-A2
L
Title Part No.
mm inch
1 ASD-ABEN0003 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-ABEN0005 5000 100 197 4
L
Title Part No. Straight
mm inch
1 ASD-CAEN1003 3106A-20-29S 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-CAEN1005 3106A-20-29S 5000 100 197 4
355±10
L
Title Part No. Manufacturer
Housing AMP (1-172161-9) AMP
MOTOR
Terminal AMP (170359-3) AMP
SIDE
CLAMP DELTA (34703237XX) DELTA
PLUG 3M 10120-3000PE 3M
DRIVE SIDE
SHELL 3M 10320-52A0-008 3M
L
Title Part No.
mm inch
1 ASD-A2EB0003 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-A2EB0005 5000 100 197 4
Delta Part Number: ASD-A2EB1003, ASD-A2EB1005
L
Title Model Name
mm inch
1 ASD-A2EB1003 3000 100 118 4
2 ASD-A2EB1005 5000 100 197 4
Detail A
Title Part No. Manufacturer
Terminal A2004WV0-2P JWT
Detail B
Title Part No. Manufacturer
Housing A2004H00-2P JWT
Terminal A2004TOP-2 JWT
Detail A, B
Title Part No. Manufacturer
Housing A2004H00-2P JWT
Terminal A2004TOP-2 JWT
Batte
ery Boxes
72 5
72.5
68
45
35 22 26
5
64.5
Units: mm Units
s: mm
I/O S
Signal Con
nnector
V
Vendor Nam
me Vendor P//N
3M
M TAIWAN LTD
L 10150-3000
1 0PE
3M
M TAIWAN LTD
L 10350-52A00-008
Term
minal Block
k Module
Revision Dece
ember 2014 A-13
3
Appendix A A
Accessories ASDA-A2
2
RS-2
232 Comm
munication Cable
L
Title Part N
No.
mm inch
1 ASD-CAR
RS0003 3000 100 118 4
Communicatio
on Cable between
b D
Drive and Computer
C r (for PC)
L
Title Part N
No.
mm inch
1 DOP-CAU
USBAB 1400 30 55 1.2
CANo
open Com
mmunication Cable
L
Title Part N
No.
mm inch
1 TAP-CB
B03 300 10 11 0.4
2 TAP-CB
B05 500 10
1 19 0.4
CANo
open Disttribution Box
B
RS-4
485 Conne
ector
Revision Dece
ember 2014 A-15
5
Appendix A Accessories ASDA-A2
25
14.5
41.3
52.4
1. 2.
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names are for optional configurations. Please refer to
the ordering information of the actual purchased product.
2) The boxes (△) in the model names are for encoder resolution types. Please refer to Chapter 1 for further
information.
3) The boxes () in the model names represent brake or keyway / oil seal.
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
1.5kW Servo Drive and 1kW Low Inertia Servo Motor
Servo Drive ASD-A2-1543-
Low Inertia Servo Motor ECMA-J△1010S
Motor Power Cable (Without Brake) ASD-CAPW100X
Motor Power Cable (With Brake) ASD-CAPW110X
Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000
Incremental Type Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN100X
Absolute Type Encoder Cable ASD-A2EB100X
Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
(X=3 indicates that the cable length is 3m; X=5 indicates that the cable length is 5m)
NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names. For the actual model name, please refer to
the ordering information of the actual purchased product.
2) The boxes (△) in the model names are for encoder resolution types. Please refer to Chapter 1 for further
information.
3) The boxes () in the model names represent brake or keyway / oil seal.
Inspection
Basic Inspection
Item Content
Periodically check if the screws of the servo drive, the connection
between the motor shaft and the mechanical system as well as the
connection of terminal block and mechanical system are securely
tightened.
The gap of the control chamber and the installation of the cooling fan
should free from oil, water or metallic particles. Also, the servo drive
General inspection shall free from the cutting power of the power drill.
If the control chamber is installed in the site which contains harmful gas
or full of dust, please be ensured the servo drive is free from the
harmful gas and dust.
When making encoder cable or wire rods, please be ensured the wiring
is correct. Otherwise, the motor may have sudden unintended
acceleration or be burned.
To avoid the electric shock, the ground terminal of the servo drive
should firmly connect to the ground terminal of the control chamber. If
the wiring is needed, wait at least 10 minutes after disconnecting the
drive from the main supply power, or discharge electricity by discharge
device.
The splicing parts of the wiring terminal should be isolated.
Make sure the wiring is correct so as to avoid the damage or any
abnormity.
Inspection before Check if the electric conductivity objects including sheetmetal (such as
operation screws) or inflammable objects are not inside the servo drive.
(has not applied to the Check if the control switch is in OFF status.
power yet)
Do not place the servo drive of external regenerative resistor on
inflammable objects.
To avoid the electromagnetic brake losing efficacy, please check if stop
function and circuit break function can work normally.
If the peripheral devices are interfered by the electronic instruments,
please reduce electromagnetic interference with devices.
Please make sure the external voltage level of the servo drive is
correct.
The encoder cable should avoid excessive stress. When the motor is
Inspection before
running, please be ensured the cable is not frayed or over extended.
running the servo drive Please contact with Delta if there is any vibration of the servo motor or
(has already applied to unusual noise during the operation.
the power) Make sure the setting of the parameters is correct. Different machinery
has different characteristic, please adjust the parameter according to
the characteristic of each machinery.
Please reset the parameter when the servo drive is in the status of
SERVO OFF, or it may cause malfunction.
When the relay is operating, make sure it can work properly.
Check if the power indicator and LED display works normally.
Maintenance
Please use and store the product in a proper site.
Periodically clean the surface of the servo drive and servo motor so as to avoid the dust and
dirt.
Periodically clean the ventilation ports of the servo drive and do not use the product in a high-
temperature site for a long time so as to avoid the malfunction.
Relay
The contact of switching power supply will wear and leads to poor contact. The lifetime of
relay is influenced by the power supply capacity; thus, the accumulative time of switching
power supply is about 100,000 times.
Cooling Fan
In continuous operation, the lifetime of the cooling fan is 2 to 3 years. However, if there is any
unusual noise or vibration during inspection, place a new one is a must.